Prefer plain 'static' to 'static inline'.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
27
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
31
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
36
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
42
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
44
45 #include "systime.h"
46
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
52
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "fontset.h"
73 #include "xsettings.h"
74 #include "xgselect.h"
75 #include "sysselect.h"
76
77 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
78 #include <X11/Shell.h>
79 #endif
80
81 #include <unistd.h>
82
83 #ifdef USE_GTK
84 #include "gtkutil.h"
85 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
86 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
87 #endif
88 #endif
89
90 #ifdef USE_LUCID
91 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
92 #endif
93
94 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
95 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
96 #define HACK_EDITRES
97 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
98 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99
100 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101
102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
103 #if defined USE_MOTIF
104 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
105 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
106 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107
108 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
112 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
114 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
115 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
116 #ifndef XtNpickTop
117 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
118 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
119 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
120 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121
122 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123
124 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
125 #include "widget.h"
126 #ifndef XtNinitialState
127 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
128 #endif
129 #endif
130
131 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132
133 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
134 #ifdef USE_XIM
135 int use_xim = 1;
136 #else
137 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
138 #endif
139
140 \f
141
142 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
143 start. */
144
145 static int any_help_event_p;
146
147 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
148 static Lisp_Object last_window;
149
150 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
151 use. */
152
153 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
154
155 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
156 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
157 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
158 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
159
160 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
161
162 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
163
164 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
165
166 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
167
168 static struct {
169 struct frame *f;
170 int eventtype;
171 } pending_event_wait;
172
173 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
174 /* The application context for Xt use. */
175 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
176 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
177
178 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
179
180 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
181 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
182
183 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
184 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
185 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
186
187 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
188
189 /* Mouse movement.
190
191 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
192 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
193 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
194 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
195
196 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
197
198 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
199 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
200 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
201 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
202 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
203 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
204 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
205 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
206 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
207 is off. */
208
209 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
210
211 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
212 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
213 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
214
215 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
216
217 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
218 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
219 an ordinary motion.
220
221 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
222 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
223 event. */
224
225 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
226
227 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
228 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
229 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
230 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
231 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
232 it's somewhat accurate. */
233
234 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
235
236 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
237
238 static Time last_user_time;
239
240 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
241 events. */
242
243 static int volatile input_signal_count;
244
245 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
246
247 static int x_noop_count;
248
249 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
252 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
253
254 #ifdef USE_GTK
255 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
256 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
257
258 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
259 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
263 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
264
265 enum xembed_info
266 {
267 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
268 };
269
270 enum xembed_message
271 {
272 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
273 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
274 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
275 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
276 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
277 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
280
281 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
282 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
283 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
284 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
285 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
286 };
287
288 /* Used in x_flush. */
289
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
296
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
318
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
344
345
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
347
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
350 {
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
355
356 block_input ();
357 if (f == NULL)
358 {
359 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
360 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
361 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
362 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
363 }
364 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
365 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
366 unblock_input ();
367 }
368
369
370 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
371 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
372 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
373 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
374 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
375 performance. */
376
377 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
378
379 \f
380 /***********************************************************************
381 Debugging
382 ***********************************************************************/
383
384 #if 0
385
386 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
387 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
388
389 struct record
390 {
391 char *locus;
392 int type;
393 };
394
395 struct record event_record[100];
396
397 int event_record_index;
398
399 void
400 record_event (char *locus, int type)
401 {
402 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
403 event_record_index = 0;
404
405 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
406 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
407 event_record_index++;
408 }
409
410 #endif /* 0 */
411
412
413 \f
414 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
415
416 struct x_display_info *
417 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
418 {
419 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
420
421 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
422 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
423 return dpyinfo;
424
425 return 0;
426 }
427
428 static Window
429 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
430 {
431 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
432 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
433 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
434
435 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
436 {
437 Window root;
438 Window *children;
439 unsigned int nchildren;
440
441 win = wi;
442 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
443 XFree (children);
444 }
445
446 return win;
447 }
448
449 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
450
451 void
452 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
453 {
454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
455 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
456 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
457 double alpha = 1.0;
458 double alpha_min = 1.0;
459 unsigned long opac;
460 Window parent;
461
462 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
463 alpha = f->alpha[0];
464 else
465 alpha = f->alpha[1];
466
467 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
468 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
469 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
471
472 if (alpha < 0.0)
473 return;
474 else if (alpha > 1.0)
475 alpha = 1.0;
476 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
477 alpha = alpha_min;
478
479 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
480
481 x_catch_errors (dpy);
482
483 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
484 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
485 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
486 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
487
488 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
489 if (parent != None)
490 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
491 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
492 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
493
494 /* return unless necessary */
495 {
496 unsigned char *data;
497 Atom actual;
498 int rc, format;
499 unsigned long n, left;
500
501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
502 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
503 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
504 &data);
505
506 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
507 {
508 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
509 XFree (data);
510 if (value == opac)
511 {
512 x_uncatch_errors ();
513 return;
514 }
515 }
516 }
517
518 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
519 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
520 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
521 x_uncatch_errors ();
522 }
523
524 int
525 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
526 {
527 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
528 }
529
530 int
531 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
532 {
533 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 }
535
536 \f
537 /***********************************************************************
538 Starting and ending an update
539 ***********************************************************************/
540
541 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
542 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
543 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
544 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
545 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
546
547 static void
548 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
549 {
550 /* Nothing to do. */
551 }
552
553
554 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
555 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
556 position of W. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
560 {
561 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
562 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
563
564 updated_window = w;
565 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
566
567 block_input ();
568
569 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
570 {
571 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
572 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
573
574 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
575 highlighting. */
576 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
577 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
578 }
579
580 unblock_input ();
581 }
582
583
584 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
585
586 static void
587 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
588 {
589 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
590 struct face *face;
591
592 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
593 if (face)
594 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
595 face->foreground);
596
597 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
598 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
599 }
600
601 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
602
603 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
604 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
605
606 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
607 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
608 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
609
610 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
611 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
612 here. */
613
614 static void
615 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
616 {
617 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
618
619 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
620 {
621 block_input ();
622
623 if (cursor_on_p)
624 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
625 output_cursor.vpos,
626 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
627
628 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
629 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
630
631 unblock_input ();
632 }
633
634 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
635 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
636 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
637 {
638 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
639 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
641 }
642
643 updated_window = NULL;
644 }
645
646
647 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
648 update_end. */
649
650 static void
651 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
652 {
653 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
654 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
655
656 #ifndef XFlush
657 block_input ();
658 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
659 unblock_input ();
660 #endif
661 }
662
663
664 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
665 complete update has been performed. The global variable
666 updated_window is not available here. */
667
668 static void
669 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
670 {
671 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
672 {
673 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
674
675 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
676 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
677 {
678 block_input ();
679 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
680 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
681 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
682 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
683 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
684 unblock_input ();
685 }
686 }
687 }
688
689
690 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
691 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
692 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
693 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
694 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
695 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
696
697 static void
698 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
699 {
700 struct window *w = updated_window;
701 struct frame *f;
702 int width, height;
703
704 eassert (w);
705
706 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
707 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
708
709 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
710 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
711 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
712 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
713 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
714 overhead is very small. */
715 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
716 && desired_row->full_width_p
717 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
718 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
719 width != 0)
720 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
721 height > 0))
722 {
723 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
724
725 block_input ();
726 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
727 0, y, width, height, False);
728 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
729 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
730 y, width, height, False);
731 unblock_input ();
732 }
733 }
734
735 static void
736 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
737 {
738 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
739 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
740 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
741 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
742 struct face *face = p->face;
743
744 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
745 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
746
747 if (!p->overlay_p)
748 {
749 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
750
751 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
752 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
753 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
754 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
755 if (face->stipple)
756 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
757 else
758 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
759
760 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
761 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
762 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
763 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
764 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
765 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
766 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
767 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
768 {
769 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
770
771 if (sb_width > 0)
772 {
773 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
774 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
775 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
776
777 if (bx < 0)
778 {
779 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
780 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
781 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
782 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
783 bx = bar_area_x;
784 if (bx >= 0)
785 {
786 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
787
788 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
789 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
790 row->y));
791 ny = row->visible_height;
792 }
793 }
794 else
795 {
796 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
797 {
798 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
799 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
800 }
801 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
802 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 }
804 }
805 }
806 #endif
807 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
808 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
809
810 if (!face->stipple)
811 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
812 }
813
814 if (p->which)
815 {
816 char *bits;
817 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
818 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
819 XGCValues gcv;
820
821 if (p->wd > 8)
822 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
823 else
824 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
825
826 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
827 by the server. */
828 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
829 (p->cursor_p
830 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
831 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
832 : face->foreground),
833 face->background, depth);
834
835 if (p->overlay_p)
836 {
837 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
838 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
839 bits, p->wd, p->h,
840 1, 0, 1);
841 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
842 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
843 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
844 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
845 }
846
847 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
848 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
849 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
850
851 if (p->overlay_p)
852 {
853 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
854 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
855 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
856 }
857 }
858
859 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
860 }
861
862 \f
863
864 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
865 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
866 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
867 rarely happens). */
868
869 static void
870 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
871 {
872 }
873
874 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
875 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
876
877 static void
878 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
879 {
880 }
881
882 \f
883 /***********************************************************************
884 Glyph display
885 ***********************************************************************/
886
887
888
889 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
891 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
892 int);
893 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
897 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
898 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
899 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
900 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
901 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
902 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
903 unsigned long *, double, int);
904 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
905 double, int, unsigned long);
906 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
907 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
911 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
912 int, int, int);
913 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
914 int, int, int, int, int, int,
915 XRectangle *);
916 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
917 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
918 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
919
920 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
921 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
922 #endif
923
924
925 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
926 face. */
927
928 static void
929 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
930 {
931 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
932 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
933 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
934 && !s->cmp)
935 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
936 else
937 {
938 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
939 XGCValues xgcv;
940 unsigned long mask;
941
942 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
943 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
944
945 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
946 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
947 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
948 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
949 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
950 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
951 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
952
953 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
954 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
955 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
956 {
957 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
958 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
959 }
960
961 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
962 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
963 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
964
965 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
966 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
967 mask, &xgcv);
968 else
969 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
970 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
971
972 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
973 }
974 }
975
976
977 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
978
979 static void
980 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
981 {
982 int face_id;
983 struct face *face;
984
985 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
986 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
987 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
988 if (face == NULL)
989 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
990
991 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
992 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
993 else
994 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
995 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
996 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
997
998 if (s->font == s->face->font)
999 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1000 else
1001 {
1002 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1003 except for FONT. */
1004 XGCValues xgcv;
1005 unsigned long mask;
1006
1007 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1008 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1009 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1010 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1011
1012 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1013 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1014 mask, &xgcv);
1015 else
1016 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1017 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1018
1019 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1020
1021 }
1022 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1023 }
1024
1025
1026 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1027 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1028 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1029
1030 static void
1031 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1032 {
1033 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1034 }
1035
1036
1037 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1038 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1039 pattern. */
1040
1041 static void
1042 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1043 {
1044 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1045
1046 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1047 {
1048 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1049 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1050 }
1051 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1052 {
1053 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1054 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1055 }
1056 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1057 {
1058 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1059 s->stippled_p = 0;
1060 }
1061 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1062 {
1063 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1064 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1065 }
1066 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1067 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1068 {
1069 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1070 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1071 }
1072 else
1073 {
1074 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1075 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1076 }
1077
1078 /* GC must have been set. */
1079 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1080 }
1081
1082
1083 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1084 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1085
1086 static void
1087 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1088 {
1089 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1090 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1091
1092 if (n > 0)
1093 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1094 s->num_clips = n;
1095 }
1096
1097
1098 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1099 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1100 the area of SRC. */
1101
1102 static void
1103 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1104 {
1105 XRectangle r;
1106
1107 r.x = src->x;
1108 r.width = src->width;
1109 r.y = src->y;
1110 r.height = src->height;
1111 dst->clip[0] = r;
1112 dst->num_clips = 1;
1113 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1114 }
1115
1116
1117 /* RIF:
1118 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1119
1120 static void
1121 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1122 {
1123 if (s->cmp == NULL
1124 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1125 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1126 {
1127 struct font_metrics metrics;
1128
1129 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1130 {
1131 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1132 struct font *font = s->font;
1133 int i;
1134
1135 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1136 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1137 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1138 }
1139 else
1140 {
1141 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1142
1143 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1144 }
1145 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1146 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1147 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1148 }
1149 else if (s->cmp)
1150 {
1151 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1152 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1153 }
1154 }
1155
1156
1157 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1158
1159 static void
1160 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1161 {
1162 XGCValues xgcv;
1163 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1164 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1165 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1166 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1167 }
1168
1169
1170 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1171 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1172 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1173 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1174 contains the first component of a composition. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1178 {
1179 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1180 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1181 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1182 {
1183 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1184
1185 if (s->stippled_p)
1186 {
1187 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1188 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1189 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1190 s->y + box_line_width,
1191 s->background_width,
1192 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1193 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1194 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1195 }
1196 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1197 || s->font_not_found_p
1198 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1199 || force_p)
1200 {
1201 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1202 s->background_width,
1203 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1204 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1205 }
1206 }
1207 }
1208
1209
1210 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1211
1212 static void
1213 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1214 {
1215 int i, x;
1216
1217 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1218 of S to the right of that box line. */
1219 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1220 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1221 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1222 else
1223 x = s->x;
1224
1225 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1226 loaded. */
1227 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1228 {
1229 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1230 {
1231 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1232 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1233 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1234 s->height - 1);
1235 x += g->pixel_width;
1236 }
1237 }
1238 else
1239 {
1240 struct font *font = s->font;
1241 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1242 int y;
1243
1244 if (font->vertical_centering)
1245 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1246
1247 y = s->ybase - boff;
1248 if (s->for_overlaps
1249 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1250 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1251 else
1252 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1253 if (s->face->overstrike)
1254 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1255 }
1256 }
1257
1258 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1259
1260 static void
1261 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1262 {
1263 int i, j, x;
1264 struct font *font = s->font;
1265
1266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1267 of S to the right of that box line. */
1268 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1270 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1271 else
1272 x = s->x;
1273
1274 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1275 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1276 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1277 this composition. */
1278
1279 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1280 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1281 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1282 {
1283 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1284 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1285 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1286 }
1287 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1288 {
1289 int y = s->ybase;
1290
1291 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1292 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1293 space on the left or right. */
1294 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1295 {
1296 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1297 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1298
1299 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1300 if (s->face->overstrike)
1301 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1302 }
1303 }
1304 else
1305 {
1306 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1307 Lisp_Object glyph;
1308 int y = s->ybase;
1309 int width = 0;
1310
1311 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1312 {
1313 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1314 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1315 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1316 else
1317 {
1318 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1319
1320 if (j < i)
1321 {
1322 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1323 if (s->face->overstrike)
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1325 x += width;
1326 }
1327 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1328 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1329 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1330 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1331 if (s->face->overstrike)
1332 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1333 x += wadjust;
1334 j = i + 1;
1335 width = 0;
1336 }
1337 }
1338 if (j < i)
1339 {
1340 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1341 if (s->face->overstrike)
1342 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1343 }
1344 }
1345 }
1346
1347
1348 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1349
1350 static void
1351 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1352 {
1353 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1354 XChar2b char2b[8];
1355 int x, i, j;
1356
1357 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1358 of S to the right of that box line. */
1359 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1360 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1361 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1362 else
1363 x = s->x;
1364
1365 s->char2b = char2b;
1366
1367 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1368 {
1369 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1370 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1371
1372 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1373 {
1374 if (len > 0
1375 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1376 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1377 >= 1))
1378 {
1379 Lisp_Object acronym
1380 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1381 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1382 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1383 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1384 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1385 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1386 }
1387 }
1388 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1389 {
1390 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1391 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1392 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1393 str = buf;
1394 }
1395
1396 if (str)
1397 {
1398 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1399 unsigned code;
1400
1401 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1402 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1403 {
1404 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1405 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1406 }
1407 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1408 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1409 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1410 0);
1411 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1412 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1413 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1414 0);
1415 }
1416 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1417 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1418 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1419 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1420 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1421 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1422 }
1423 }
1424
1425 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1426
1427 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1428 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1429 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1430 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1431
1432 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1433
1434 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1435 cannot be determined. */
1436
1437 static struct frame *
1438 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1439 {
1440 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1441 Lisp_Object tail;
1442 struct frame *f;
1443
1444 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1445
1446 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1447 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1448 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1449 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1450 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1451 widget = XtParent (widget);
1452
1453 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1454 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1455 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1456 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1457 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1458 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1459 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1460 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1461 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1462 return f;
1463
1464 emacs_abort ();
1465 }
1466
1467 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1468 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1469 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1470 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1471 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1472 Value is true if successful. */
1473
1474 bool
1475 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1476 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1477 {
1478 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1479 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1480 }
1481
1482 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1483
1484
1485 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1486 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1487
1488 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1489 {
1490 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1491 sizeof (Screen *)},
1492 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1493 sizeof (Colormap)}
1494 };
1495
1496
1497 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1498 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1499
1500 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1501
1502
1503 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1504
1505 DPY is the display we are working on.
1506
1507 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1508 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1509 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1510 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1511
1512 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1513 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1514
1515 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1516 we allocated the color or not.
1517
1518 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1519
1520 static Boolean
1521 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1522 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1523 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1524 {
1525 Screen *screen;
1526 Colormap cmap;
1527 Pixel pixel;
1528 String color_name;
1529 XColor color;
1530
1531 if (*nargs != 2)
1532 {
1533 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1534 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1535 "XtToolkitError",
1536 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1537 return False;
1538 }
1539
1540 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1541 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1542 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1543
1544 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1545 {
1546 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1547 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1548 }
1549 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1550 {
1551 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1552 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1553 }
1554 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1555 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1556 {
1557 pixel = color.pixel;
1558 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1559 }
1560 else
1561 {
1562 String params[1];
1563 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1564
1565 params[0] = color_name;
1566 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1567 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1568 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1569 params, &nparams);
1570 return False;
1571 }
1572
1573 if (to->addr != NULL)
1574 {
1575 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1576 {
1577 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1578 return False;
1579 }
1580
1581 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1582 }
1583 else
1584 {
1585 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1586 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1587 }
1588
1589 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1590 return True;
1591 }
1592
1593
1594 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1595 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1596 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1597
1598 APP is the application context in which we work.
1599
1600 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1601 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1602 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1603
1604 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1605
1606 static void
1607 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1608 Cardinal *nargs)
1609 {
1610 if (*nargs != 2)
1611 {
1612 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1613 "XtToolkitError",
1614 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1615 NULL, NULL);
1616 }
1617 else if (closure != NULL)
1618 {
1619 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1620 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1621 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1622 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1623 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1624 }
1625 }
1626
1627
1628 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1629
1630
1631 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1632 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1633 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1634 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1635
1636 static const XColor *
1637 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1638 {
1639 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1640
1641 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1642 {
1643 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1644 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1645 int i;
1646
1647 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1648 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1649 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1650
1651 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1652 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1653
1654 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1655 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1656 }
1657
1658 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1659 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1660 }
1661
1662
1663 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1664 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1665
1666 void
1667 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1668 {
1669 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1670
1671 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1672 {
1673 int i;
1674 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1675 {
1676 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1677 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1678 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1679 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1680 }
1681 }
1682 else
1683 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1684 }
1685
1686
1687 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1688 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1689
1690 void
1691 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1692 {
1693 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1694 }
1695
1696
1697 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1698 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1699 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1700 allocated. */
1701
1702 static bool
1703 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1704 {
1705 bool rc;
1706
1707 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1708 if (rc == 0)
1709 {
1710 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1711 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1712 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1713 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1714 int nearest, i;
1715 int max_color_delta = 255;
1716 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1717 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1718 int ncells;
1719 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1720
1721 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1722 {
1723 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1724 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1725 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1726 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1727
1728 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1729 {
1730 nearest = i;
1731 nearest_delta = delta;
1732 }
1733 }
1734
1735 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1736 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1737 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1738 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1739 }
1740 else
1741 {
1742 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1743 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1744 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1745 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1746 XColor *cached_color;
1747
1748 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1749 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1750 (cached_color->red != color->red
1751 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1752 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1753 {
1754 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1755 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1756 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1757 }
1758 }
1759
1760 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1761 if (rc)
1762 register_color (color->pixel);
1763 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1764
1765 return rc;
1766 }
1767
1768
1769 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1770 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1771 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1772 allocated. */
1773
1774 bool
1775 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1776 {
1777 gamma_correct (f, color);
1778 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1779 }
1780
1781
1782 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1783 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1784 get color reference counts right. */
1785
1786 unsigned long
1787 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1788 {
1789 XColor color;
1790
1791 color.pixel = pixel;
1792 block_input ();
1793 x_query_color (f, &color);
1794 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1795 unblock_input ();
1796 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1797 register_color (pixel);
1798 #endif
1799 return color.pixel;
1800 }
1801
1802
1803 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1804 boosted.
1805
1806 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1807 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1808 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1809 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1810 use an additional additive factor.
1811
1812 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1813 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1814 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1815
1816
1817 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1818 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1819 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1820 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1821 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1822 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1823
1824 static bool
1825 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1826 {
1827 XColor color, new;
1828 long bright;
1829 bool success_p;
1830
1831 /* Get RGB color values. */
1832 color.pixel = *pixel;
1833 x_query_color (f, &color);
1834
1835 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1836 eassert (factor >= 0);
1837 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1838 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1839 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1840
1841 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1842 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1843
1844 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1845 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1846 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1847 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1848 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1849 {
1850 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1851 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1852 /* The additive adjustment. */
1853 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1854
1855 if (factor < 1)
1856 {
1857 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1858 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1859 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1860 }
1861 else
1862 {
1863 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1864 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1865 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1866 }
1867 }
1868
1869 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1870 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1871 if (success_p)
1872 {
1873 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1874 {
1875 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1876 delta to the RGB values. */
1877 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1878
1879 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1880 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1881 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1882 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1883 }
1884 else
1885 success_p = 1;
1886 *pixel = new.pixel;
1887 }
1888
1889 return success_p;
1890 }
1891
1892
1893 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1894 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1895 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1896 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1897 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1898 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1899
1900 static void
1901 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1902 {
1903 XGCValues xgcv;
1904 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1905 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1906 unsigned long pixel;
1907 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1908 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1909 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1910 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1911
1912 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1913 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1914
1915 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1916 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1917 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1918 if (relief->gc
1919 && relief->allocated_p)
1920 {
1921 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1922 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1923 }
1924
1925 /* Allocate new color. */
1926 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1927 pixel = background;
1928 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1929 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1930 {
1931 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1932 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1933 }
1934
1935 if (relief->gc == 0)
1936 {
1937 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1938 mask |= GCStipple;
1939 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1940 }
1941 else
1942 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1943 }
1944
1945
1946 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1947
1948 static void
1949 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1950 {
1951 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1952 unsigned long color;
1953
1954 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1955 color = s->face->box_color;
1956 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1957 && s->img->pixmap
1958 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1959 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1960 else
1961 {
1962 XGCValues xgcv;
1963
1964 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1965 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1966 color = xgcv.background;
1967 }
1968
1969 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1970 || color != di->relief_background)
1971 {
1972 di->relief_background = color;
1973 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1974 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1975 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1976 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1977 }
1978 }
1979
1980
1981 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1982 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1983 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1984 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1985 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1986 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1987 when drawing. */
1988
1989 static void
1990 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1991 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1992 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1993 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1994 {
1995 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1996 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1997 int i;
1998 GC gc;
1999
2000 if (raised_p)
2001 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2002 else
2003 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2004 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2005
2006 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2007 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2008 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2009 corner pixels. */
2010
2011 /* Top. */
2012 if (top_p)
2013 {
2014 if (width == 1)
2015 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2016 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2017 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2018
2019 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2020 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2021 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2022 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2023 }
2024
2025 /* Left. */
2026 if (left_p)
2027 {
2028 if (width == 1)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2030
2031 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2032 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2033
2034 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2035 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2036 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2037 }
2038
2039 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2040 if (raised_p)
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 else
2043 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2044 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2045
2046 if (width > 1)
2047 {
2048 /* Outermost top line. */
2049 if (top_p)
2050 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2051 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2052 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2053
2054 /* Outermost left line. */
2055 if (left_p)
2056 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2057 }
2058
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 {
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2064 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2065 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2068 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2069 }
2070
2071 /* Right. */
2072 if (right_p)
2073 {
2074 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2075 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2076 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2077 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2078 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2079 }
2080
2081 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2082 }
2083
2084
2085 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2086 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2087 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2088 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2089 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2090 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2091
2092 static void
2093 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2094 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2095 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2096 {
2097 XGCValues xgcv;
2098
2099 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2101 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2102
2103 /* Top. */
2104 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2105 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2106
2107 /* Left. */
2108 if (left_p)
2109 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2110 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2111
2112 /* Bottom. */
2113 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2114 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2115
2116 /* Right. */
2117 if (right_p)
2118 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2119 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2120
2121 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2122 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2123 }
2124
2125
2126 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2127
2128 static void
2129 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2130 {
2131 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2132 int left_p, right_p;
2133 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2134 XRectangle clip_rect;
2135
2136 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2137 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2138 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2181 {
2182 int x = s->x;
2183 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2184
2185 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2186 right of that line. */
2187 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2188 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2189 && s->slice.x == 0)
2190 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2191
2192 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2193 by that margin. */
2194 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2195 x += s->img->hmargin;
2196 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2197 y += s->img->vmargin;
2198
2199 if (s->img->pixmap)
2200 {
2201 if (s->img->mask)
2202 {
2203 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2204 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2205 trust on the shape extension to be available
2206 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2207 manually. */
2208 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2209 | GCFunction);
2210 XGCValues xgcv;
2211 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2212
2213 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2214 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2215 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2216 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2217 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2218
2219 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2220 image_rect.x = x;
2221 image_rect.y = y;
2222 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2223 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2224 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2225 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2226 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2227 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 {
2231 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2232
2233 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2234 image_rect.x = x;
2235 image_rect.y = y;
2236 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2237 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2238 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2239 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2240 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2241 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2242
2243 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2244 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2245 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2246 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2247 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2248 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2249 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2250 {
2251 int relief = s->img->relief;
2252 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2253 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2254 x - relief, y - relief,
2255 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2256 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2257 }
2258 }
2259 }
2260 else
2261 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2263 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2264 }
2265
2266
2267 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2268
2269 static void
2270 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2271 {
2272 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2273 int extra_x, extra_y;
2274 XRectangle r;
2275 int x = s->x;
2276 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2277
2278 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2279 right of that line. */
2280 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2281 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2282 && s->slice.x == 0)
2283 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2284
2285 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2286 by that margin. */
2287 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2288 x += s->img->hmargin;
2289 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2290 y += s->img->vmargin;
2291
2292 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2293 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2294 {
2295 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2296 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2297 }
2298 else
2299 {
2300 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2301 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2302 }
2303
2304 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2305 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2306 {
2307 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2308 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2309 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2310 {
2311 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2312 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2313 }
2314 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2315 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2316 }
2317
2318 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2319 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2320 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2321 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2322
2323 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2324 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2325 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2326 s->slice.y == 0,
2327 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2328 s->slice.x == 0,
2329 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2330 &r);
2331 }
2332
2333
2334 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2335
2336 static void
2337 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2338 {
2339 int x = 0;
2340 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2341
2342 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2343 right of that line. */
2344 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2345 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2346 && s->slice.x == 0)
2347 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2348
2349 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2350 by that margin. */
2351 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2352 x += s->img->hmargin;
2353 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2354 y += s->img->vmargin;
2355
2356 if (s->img->pixmap)
2357 {
2358 if (s->img->mask)
2359 {
2360 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2361 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2362 trust on the shape extension to be available
2363 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2364 manually. */
2365 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2366 | GCFunction);
2367 XGCValues xgcv;
2368
2369 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2370 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2371 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2372 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2373 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2374
2375 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2376 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2377 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2378 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2379 }
2380 else
2381 {
2382 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2383 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2384 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2385
2386 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2387 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2388 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2389 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2390 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2391 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2392 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2393 {
2394 int r = s->img->relief;
2395 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2396 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2397 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2398 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2399 }
2400 }
2401 }
2402 else
2403 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2405 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2406 }
2407
2408
2409 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2410 give the rectangle to draw. */
2411
2412 static void
2413 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2414 {
2415 if (s->stippled_p)
2416 {
2417 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2418 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2419 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2420 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2421 }
2422 else
2423 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2424 }
2425
2426
2427 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2428
2429 s->y
2430 s->x +-------------------------
2431 | s->face->box
2432 |
2433 | +-------------------------
2434 | | s->img->margin
2435 | |
2436 | | +-------------------
2437 | | | the image
2438
2439 */
2440
2441 static void
2442 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2443 {
2444 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2445 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2446 int height;
2447 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2448
2449 height = s->height;
2450 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2451 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2452 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2453 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2454
2455 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2456 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2457 flickering. */
2458 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2459 if (height > s->slice.height
2460 || s->img->hmargin
2461 || s->img->vmargin
2462 || s->img->mask
2463 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2464 || s->width != s->background_width)
2465 {
2466 if (s->img->mask)
2467 {
2468 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2469 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2470 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2471 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2472 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2473
2474 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2475 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2476 s->background_width,
2477 s->height, depth);
2478
2479 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2480 pixmap. */
2481 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2482
2483 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2484 if (s->stippled_p)
2485 {
2486 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2487 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2488 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2489 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2490 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2491 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2492 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2493 }
2494 else
2495 {
2496 XGCValues xgcv;
2497 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2498 &xgcv);
2499 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2500 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2501 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2502 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2503 }
2504 }
2505 else
2506 {
2507 int x = s->x;
2508 int y = s->y;
2509
2510 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2511 && s->slice.x == 0)
2512 x += box_line_hwidth;
2513
2514 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2515 y += box_line_vwidth;
2516
2517 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2518 }
2519
2520 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2521 }
2522
2523 /* Draw the foreground. */
2524 if (pixmap != None)
2525 {
2526 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2527 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2528 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2529 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2530 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2531 }
2532 else
2533 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2534
2535 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2536 if (s->img->relief
2537 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2538 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2539 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2540 }
2541
2542
2543 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2544
2545 static void
2546 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2547 {
2548 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2549
2550 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2551 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2552 {
2553 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2554 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2555 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2556 int x = s->x;
2557
2558 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2559 {
2560 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2561
2562 if (x < left_x)
2563 {
2564 background_width -= left_x - x;
2565 x = left_x;
2566 }
2567 }
2568 else
2569 {
2570 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2571 stretch glyph. */
2572 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2573
2574 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2575 background_width -= x - right_x;
2576 x += background_width;
2577 }
2578 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2579 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2580 x -= width;
2581
2582 /* Draw cursor. */
2583 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2584
2585 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2586 if (width < background_width)
2587 {
2588 int y = s->y;
2589 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2590 XRectangle r;
2591 GC gc;
2592
2593 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2594 x += width;
2595 else
2596 x = s->x;
2597 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2598 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2599 {
2600 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2601 gc = s->gc;
2602 }
2603 else
2604 gc = s->face->gc;
2605
2606 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2607 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2608
2609 if (s->face->stipple)
2610 {
2611 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2612 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2613 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2614 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2615 }
2616 else
2617 {
2618 XGCValues xgcv;
2619 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2620 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2621 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2622 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2623 }
2624 }
2625 }
2626 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2627 {
2628 int background_width = s->background_width;
2629 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2630
2631 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2632 except for header line and mode line. */
2633 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2634 {
2635 background_width -= left_x - x;
2636 x = left_x;
2637 }
2638 if (background_width > 0)
2639 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2640 }
2641
2642 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2643 }
2644
2645 /*
2646 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2647
2648 x0 wave_length = 2
2649 --
2650 y0 * * * * *
2651 |* * * * * * * * *
2652 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2653
2654 */
2655
2656 static void
2657 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2658 {
2659 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2660 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2661 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2662
2663 dx = wave_length;
2664 dy = wave_height - 1;
2665 x0 = s->x;
2666 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2667 width = s->width;
2668 xmax = x0 + width;
2669
2670 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2671
2672 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2673 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2674
2675 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2676 return;
2677
2678 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2679
2680 /* Draw the waves */
2681
2682 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2683 x2 = x1 + dx;
2684 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2685 y1 = y2 = y0;
2686
2687 if (odd)
2688 y1 += dy;
2689 else
2690 y2 += dy;
2691
2692 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2693 emacs_abort ();
2694
2695 while (x1 <= xmax)
2696 {
2697 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2698 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2699 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2700 odd = !odd;
2701 }
2702
2703 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2704 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2705 }
2706
2707
2708 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2709
2710 static void
2711 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2712 {
2713 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2714
2715 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2716 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2717 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2718 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2719 {
2720 int width;
2721 struct glyph_string *next;
2722
2723 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2724 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2725 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2726 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2727 {
2728 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2729 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2730 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2731 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2732 else
2733 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2734 next->num_clips = 0;
2735 }
2736 }
2737
2738 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2739 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2740
2741 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2742 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2743 if (!s->for_overlaps
2744 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2745 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2746 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2747
2748 {
2749 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2750 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2751 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2752 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2753 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2754 }
2755 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2756 && !s->clip_tail
2757 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2758 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2759 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2760 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2761 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2762 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2763 else
2764 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2765
2766 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2767 {
2768 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2769 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2770 break;
2771
2772 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2773 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2774 break;
2775
2776 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2777 if (s->for_overlaps)
2778 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2779 else
2780 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2781 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2782 break;
2783
2784 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2785 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2786 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2787 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2788 else
2789 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2790 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2791 break;
2792
2793 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2794 if (s->for_overlaps)
2795 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2796 else
2797 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2798 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2799 break;
2800
2801 default:
2802 emacs_abort ();
2803 }
2804
2805 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2806 {
2807 /* Draw underline. */
2808 if (s->face->underline_p)
2809 {
2810 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2811 {
2812 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2813 x_draw_underwave (s);
2814 else
2815 {
2816 XGCValues xgcv;
2817 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2818 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2819 x_draw_underwave (s);
2820 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2821 }
2822 }
2823 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2824 {
2825 unsigned long thickness, position;
2826 int y;
2827
2828 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2829 {
2830 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2831 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2832 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2833 }
2834 else
2835 {
2836 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2837 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2838 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2839 else
2840 thickness = 1;
2841 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2842 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2843 else
2844 {
2845 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2846 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2847 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2848 specs, and its default is
2849
2850 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2851 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2852
2853 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2854 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2855 position = s->font->underline_position;
2856 else if (s->font)
2857 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2858 else
2859 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2860 }
2861 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2862 }
2863 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2864 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2865 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2866 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2867 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2868 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2869 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2870 s->underline_position = position;
2871 y = s->ybase + position;
2872 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2873 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2874 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2875 else
2876 {
2877 XGCValues xgcv;
2878 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2879 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2880 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2881 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2882 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2883 }
2884 }
2885 }
2886 /* Draw overline. */
2887 if (s->face->overline_p)
2888 {
2889 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2890
2891 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2892 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2893 s->width, h);
2894 else
2895 {
2896 XGCValues xgcv;
2897 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2898 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2899 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2900 s->width, h);
2901 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2902 }
2903 }
2904
2905 /* Draw strike-through. */
2906 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2907 {
2908 unsigned long h = 1;
2909 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2910
2911 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2912 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2913 s->width, h);
2914 else
2915 {
2916 XGCValues xgcv;
2917 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2918 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2919 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2920 s->width, h);
2921 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2922 }
2923 }
2924
2925 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2926 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2927 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2928
2929 if (s->prev)
2930 {
2931 struct glyph_string *prev;
2932
2933 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2934 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2935 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2936 {
2937 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2938 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2939 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2940
2941 prev->hl = s->hl;
2942 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2943 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2944 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2945 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2946 else
2947 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2948 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2949 prev->hl = save;
2950 prev->num_clips = 0;
2951 }
2952 }
2953
2954 if (s->next)
2955 {
2956 struct glyph_string *next;
2957
2958 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2959 if (next->hl != s->hl
2960 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2961 {
2962 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2963 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2964 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2965
2966 next->hl = s->hl;
2967 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2968 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2969 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2970 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2971 else
2972 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2973 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2974 next->hl = save;
2975 next->num_clips = 0;
2976 next->clip_head = s->next;
2977 }
2978 }
2979 }
2980
2981 /* Reset clipping. */
2982 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2983 s->num_clips = 0;
2984 }
2985
2986 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2987
2988 static void
2989 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2990 {
2991 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2992 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2993 x, y, width, height,
2994 x + shift_by, y);
2995 }
2996
2997 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2998 for X frames. */
2999
3000 static void
3001 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3002 {
3003 emacs_abort ();
3004 }
3005
3006
3007 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3008 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3009
3010 void
3011 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3012 {
3013 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3014 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3015 }
3016
3017
3018 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3019
3020 static void
3021 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3022 {
3023 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3024 longer visible. */
3025 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3026 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3027 output_cursor.x = -1;
3028
3029 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3030 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3031 block_input ();
3032
3033 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3034
3035 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3036 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3037 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3038
3039 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3040 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3041 redisplay, do it here. */
3042 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3043 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3044 #endif
3045
3046 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3047
3048 unblock_input ();
3049 }
3050
3051
3052 \f
3053 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3054
3055 static void
3056 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3057 {
3058 block_input ();
3059
3060 {
3061 #ifdef USE_GTK
3062 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3063 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3064 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3065 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3066 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3067 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3068 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3069 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3070 do { \
3071 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3072 cairo_fill (cr); \
3073 } \
3074 while (0)
3075 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3076 GdkGCValues vals;
3077 GdkGC *gc;
3078 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3079 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3080 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3081 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3082 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3083 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3084 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3085 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3086 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3087 GC gc;
3088
3089 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3090 pixels into background pixels. */
3091 {
3092 XGCValues values;
3093
3094 values.function = GXxor;
3095 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3096 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3097
3098 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3099 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3100 }
3101 #endif
3102 {
3103 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3104 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3105 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3106 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3107 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3108 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3109 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3110
3111 int width;
3112
3113 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3114 edge it is next to. */
3115 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3116 {
3117 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3118 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3119 break;
3120
3121 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3122 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3123 break;
3124
3125 default:
3126 break;
3127 }
3128
3129 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3130
3131 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3132 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3133 {
3134 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3135 flash_left,
3136 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3137 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3138 width, flash_height);
3139 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3140 flash_left,
3141 (height - flash_height
3142 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3143 width, flash_height);
3144
3145 }
3146 else
3147 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3148 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3149 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3150 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3151
3152 x_flush (f);
3153
3154 {
3155 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3156 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3157
3158 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3159 available. */
3160 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3161 {
3162 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3163 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3164
3165 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3166 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3167 break;
3168
3169 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3170 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3171
3172 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3173 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3174 }
3175 }
3176
3177 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3178 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3179 {
3180 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3181 flash_left,
3182 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3183 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3184 width, flash_height);
3185 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3186 flash_left,
3187 (height - flash_height
3188 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3189 width, flash_height);
3190 }
3191 else
3192 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3193 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3194 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3195 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3196
3197 #ifdef USE_GTK
3198 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3199 cairo_destroy (cr);
3200 #else
3201 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3202 #endif
3203 #undef XFillRectangle
3204 #else
3205 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3206 #endif
3207 x_flush (f);
3208 }
3209 }
3210
3211 unblock_input ();
3212 }
3213
3214
3215 static void
3216 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3217 {
3218 block_input ();
3219 if (invisible)
3220 {
3221 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3222 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3223 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3224 }
3225 else
3226 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3227 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3228 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3229 unblock_input ();
3230 }
3231
3232
3233 /* Make audible bell. */
3234
3235 static void
3236 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3237 {
3238 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3239 {
3240 if (visible_bell)
3241 XTflash (f);
3242 else
3243 {
3244 block_input ();
3245 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3246 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3247 unblock_input ();
3248 }
3249 }
3250 }
3251
3252 \f
3253 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3254 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3255 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3256 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3257
3258 static void
3259 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3260 {
3261 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3262 }
3263
3264
3265 \f
3266 /***********************************************************************
3267 Line Dance
3268 ***********************************************************************/
3269
3270 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3271 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3272
3273 static void
3274 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3275 {
3276 emacs_abort ();
3277 }
3278
3279
3280 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3281
3282 static void
3283 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3284 {
3285 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3286 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3287
3288 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3289 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3290 fringe of W. */
3291 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3292
3293 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3294 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3295 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3296 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3297 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3298 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3299 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3300 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3301 {
3302 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3303
3304 if (sb_width > 0)
3305 {
3306 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3307 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3308 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3309
3310 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3311 {
3312 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3313 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3314 }
3315 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3316 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3317 }
3318 }
3319 #endif
3320
3321 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3322 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3323 bottom_y = y + height;
3324
3325 if (to_y < from_y)
3326 {
3327 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3328 line at the bottom. */
3329 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3330 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3331 else
3332 height = run->height;
3333 }
3334 else
3335 {
3336 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3337 at the bottom. */
3338 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3339 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3340 else
3341 height = run->height;
3342 }
3343
3344 block_input ();
3345
3346 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3347 updated_window = w;
3348 x_clear_cursor (w);
3349
3350 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3351 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3352 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3353 x, from_y,
3354 width, height,
3355 x, to_y);
3356
3357 unblock_input ();
3358 }
3359
3360
3361 \f
3362 /***********************************************************************
3363 Exposure Events
3364 ***********************************************************************/
3365
3366 \f
3367 static void
3368 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3369 {
3370 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3371 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3372 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3373 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3374 block_input ();
3375 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3376 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3377 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3378 because of this (bug#9310). */
3379 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3380 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3381 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3382 x_uncatch_errors ();
3383 unblock_input ();
3384 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3385 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3386 }
3387
3388 static void
3389 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3390 {
3391 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3392 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3393 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3394 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3395 block_input ();
3396 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3397 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3398 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3399 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3400 x_uncatch_errors ();
3401 unblock_input ();
3402 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3403 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3404 }
3405
3406 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3407 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3408 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3409 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3410 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3411
3412 static void
3413 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3414 {
3415 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3416
3417 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3418 {
3419 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3420 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3421 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3422
3423 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3424 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3425
3426 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3427 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3428 else
3429 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3430 }
3431
3432 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3433 }
3434
3435 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3436 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3437 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3438
3439 static void
3440 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3441 {
3442 if (type == FocusIn)
3443 {
3444 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3445 {
3446 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3447 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3448
3449 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3450 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3451 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3452 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3453 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3454 {
3455 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3456 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3457 }
3458 }
3459
3460 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3461
3462 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3463 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3464 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3465 #endif
3466 }
3467 else if (type == FocusOut)
3468 {
3469 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3470
3471 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3472 {
3473 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3474 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3475 }
3476
3477 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3478 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3479 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3480 #endif
3481 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3482 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3483 }
3484 }
3485
3486 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3487 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3488
3489 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3490
3491 static void
3492 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3493 {
3494 struct frame *frame;
3495
3496 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3497 if (! frame)
3498 return;
3499
3500 switch (event->type)
3501 {
3502 case EnterNotify:
3503 case LeaveNotify:
3504 {
3505 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3506 int focus_state
3507 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3508
3509 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3510 && event->xcrossing.focus
3511 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3512 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3513 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3514 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3515 }
3516 break;
3517
3518 case FocusIn:
3519 case FocusOut:
3520 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3521 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3522 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3523 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3524 break;
3525
3526 case ClientMessage:
3527 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3528 {
3529 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3530 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3531 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3532 }
3533 break;
3534 }
3535 }
3536
3537
3538 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3539 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3540
3541 void
3542 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3543 {
3544 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3545 }
3546 #endif
3547
3548 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3549 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3550 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3551
3552 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3553 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3554 the appropriate X display info. */
3555
3556 static void
3557 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3558 {
3559 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3560 }
3561
3562 static void
3563 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3564 {
3565 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3566
3567 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3568 {
3569 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3570 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3571 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3572 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3573 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3574 {
3575 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3576 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3577 }
3578 }
3579 else
3580 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3581
3582 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3583 {
3584 if (old_highlight)
3585 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3586 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3587 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3588 }
3589 }
3590
3591
3592 \f
3593 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3594
3595 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3596 static void
3597 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3598 {
3599 int min_code, max_code;
3600 KeySym *syms;
3601 int syms_per_code;
3602 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3603
3604 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3605 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3606 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3607 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3608 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3609
3610 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3611
3612 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3613 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3614 &syms_per_code);
3615 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3616
3617 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3618 Alt keysyms are on. */
3619 {
3620 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3621 int found_alt_or_meta;
3622
3623 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3624 {
3625 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3626 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3627 {
3628 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3629
3630 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3631 if (code == 0)
3632 continue;
3633
3634 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3635 {
3636 int code_col;
3637
3638 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3639 {
3640 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3641
3642 switch (sym)
3643 {
3644 case XK_Meta_L:
3645 case XK_Meta_R:
3646 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3647 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3648 break;
3649
3650 case XK_Alt_L:
3651 case XK_Alt_R:
3652 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3653 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3654 break;
3655
3656 case XK_Hyper_L:
3657 case XK_Hyper_R:
3658 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3659 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3660 code_col = syms_per_code;
3661 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3662 break;
3663
3664 case XK_Super_L:
3665 case XK_Super_R:
3666 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3667 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3668 code_col = syms_per_code;
3669 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3670 break;
3671
3672 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3673 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3674 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3675 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3676 code_col = syms_per_code;
3677 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3678 break;
3679 }
3680 }
3681 }
3682 }
3683 }
3684 }
3685
3686 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3687 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3688 {
3689 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3690 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3691 }
3692
3693 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3694 make them just meta, not alt. */
3695 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3696 {
3697 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3698 }
3699
3700 XFree (syms);
3701 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3702 }
3703
3704 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3705 Emacs uses. */
3706
3707 int
3708 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3709 {
3710 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3711 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3712 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3713 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3714 Lisp_Object tem;
3715
3716 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3717 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3718 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3719 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3720 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3721 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3722 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3723 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3724
3725 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3726 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3727 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3728 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3729 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3730 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3731 }
3732
3733 static int
3734 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3735 {
3736 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3737 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3738 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3739 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3740
3741 Lisp_Object tem;
3742
3743 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3744 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3745 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3746 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3747 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3748 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3749 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3750 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3751
3752
3753 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3754 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3755 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3756 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3757 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3758 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3759 }
3760
3761 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3762
3763 char *
3764 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3765 {
3766 char *value;
3767
3768 block_input ();
3769 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3770 unblock_input ();
3771
3772 return value;
3773 }
3774
3775
3776 \f
3777 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3778
3779 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3780
3781 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3782 the mouse. */
3783
3784 static Lisp_Object
3785 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3786 {
3787 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3788 otherwise. */
3789 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3790 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3791 result->timestamp = event->time;
3792 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3793 event->state)
3794 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3795 ? up_modifier
3796 : down_modifier));
3797
3798 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3799 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3800 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3801 result->arg = Qnil;
3802 return Qnil;
3803 }
3804
3805 \f
3806 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3807 The input handler calls this.
3808
3809 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3810 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3811 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3812 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3813
3814 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3815 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3816
3817 static int
3818 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3819 {
3820 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3821 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3822 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3823
3824 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3825 return 0;
3826
3827 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3828 {
3829 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3831 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3832 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3833 return 1;
3834 }
3835
3836
3837 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3838 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3839 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3840 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3841 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3842 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3843 {
3844 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3845 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3846 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3847 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3848 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3849 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3850 return 1;
3851 }
3852
3853 return 0;
3854 }
3855
3856 \f
3857 /************************************************************************
3858 Mouse Face
3859 ************************************************************************/
3860
3861 static void
3862 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3863 {
3864 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3865 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3866 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3867 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3868 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3869 }
3870
3871
3872
3873 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3874 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3875
3876 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3877 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3878 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3879 position on the scroll bar.
3880
3881 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3882 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3883 the mouse is over.
3884
3885 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3886 was at this position.
3887
3888 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3889
3890 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3891 movement. */
3892
3893 static void
3894 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3895 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3896 Time *timestamp)
3897 {
3898 FRAME_PTR f1;
3899
3900 block_input ();
3901
3902 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3903 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3904 else
3905 {
3906 Window root;
3907 int root_x, root_y;
3908
3909 Window dummy_window;
3910 int dummy;
3911
3912 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3913
3914 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3915 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3916 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3917 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3918 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3919
3920 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3921
3922 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3923 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3924 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3925
3926 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3927 &root,
3928
3929 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3930 a different screen. */
3931 &dummy_window,
3932
3933 /* The position on that root window. */
3934 &root_x, &root_y,
3935
3936 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3937 &dummy, &dummy,
3938
3939 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3940 we don't care. */
3941 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3942
3943 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3944 containing the pointer. */
3945 {
3946 Window win, child;
3947 int win_x, win_y;
3948 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3949
3950 win = root;
3951
3952 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3953 structure is changing at the same time this function
3954 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3955
3956 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3957
3958 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3959 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3960 {
3961 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3962 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3963 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3964
3965 /* From-window, to-window. */
3966 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3967
3968 /* From-position, to-position. */
3969 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3970
3971 /* Child of win. */
3972 &child);
3973 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3974 }
3975 else
3976 {
3977 while (1)
3978 {
3979 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3980
3981 /* From-window, to-window. */
3982 root, win,
3983
3984 /* From-position, to-position. */
3985 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3986
3987 /* Child of win. */
3988 &child);
3989
3990 if (child == None || child == win)
3991 break;
3992 #ifdef USE_GTK
3993 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3994 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3995 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3996 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3997 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3998 break;
3999 #endif
4000 win = child;
4001 parent_x = win_x;
4002 parent_y = win_y;
4003 }
4004
4005 /* Now we know that:
4006 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4007 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4008 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4009 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4010 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4011 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4012 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4013 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4014 never use them in that case.) */
4015
4016 #ifdef USE_GTK
4017 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4018 want the edit window. */
4019 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4020 #else
4021 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4022 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4023 #endif
4024
4025 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4026 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4027 on the frame. */
4028 if (f1 != NULL
4029 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4030 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4031 f1 = NULL;
4032 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4033 }
4034
4035 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4036 f1 = 0;
4037
4038 x_uncatch_errors ();
4039
4040 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4041 if (! f1)
4042 {
4043 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4044
4045 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4046
4047 if (bar)
4048 {
4049 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4050 win_x = parent_x;
4051 win_y = parent_y;
4052 }
4053 }
4054
4055 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4056 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4057
4058 if (f1)
4059 {
4060 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4061 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4062 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4063 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4064 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4065 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4066 the frame are divided into. */
4067
4068 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4069 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4070
4071 *bar_window = Qnil;
4072 *part = 0;
4073 *fp = f1;
4074 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4075 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4076 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4077 }
4078 }
4079 }
4080
4081 unblock_input ();
4082 }
4083
4084
4085 \f
4086 /***********************************************************************
4087 Scroll bars
4088 ***********************************************************************/
4089
4090 /* Scroll bar support. */
4091
4092 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4093 manages it.
4094 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4095 bits. */
4096
4097 static struct scroll_bar *
4098 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4099 {
4100 Lisp_Object tail;
4101
4102 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4103 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4104 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4105
4106 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4107 {
4108 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4109
4110 frame = XCAR (tail);
4111 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4112 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4113 emacs_abort ();
4114
4115 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4116 continue;
4117
4118 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4119 right window ID. */
4120 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4121 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4122 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4123 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4124 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4125 condemned = Qnil,
4126 ! NILP (bar));
4127 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4128 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4129 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4130 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4131 }
4132
4133 return NULL;
4134 }
4135
4136
4137 #if defined USE_LUCID
4138
4139 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4140 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4141
4142 static Widget
4143 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4144 {
4145 Lisp_Object tail;
4146
4147 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4148 {
4149 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4150 {
4151 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4152 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4153
4154 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4155 return menu_bar;
4156 }
4157 }
4158
4159 return NULL;
4160 }
4161
4162 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4163
4164 \f
4165 /************************************************************************
4166 Toolkit scroll bars
4167 ************************************************************************/
4168
4169 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4170
4171 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4172 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4173 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4174 struct scroll_bar *);
4175 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4176 int, int, int);
4177
4178
4179 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4180 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4181
4182 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4183
4184 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4185
4186 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4187
4188 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4189 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4190
4191 #ifndef USE_GTK
4192 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4193
4194 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4195
4196 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4197
4198 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4199 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4200 to avoid jerkiness. */
4201
4202 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4203
4204 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4205 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4206 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4207 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4208
4209 static void
4210 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4211 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4212 {
4213 int scroll_bar_p;
4214 const char *end_action;
4215
4216 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4217 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4218 end_action = "Release";
4219 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4220 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4221 end_action = "EndScroll";
4222 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4223
4224 if (scroll_bar_p
4225 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4226 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4227 {
4228 struct window *w;
4229
4230 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4231 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4232 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4233
4234 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4235 {
4236 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4237 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4238 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4239 }
4240 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4241 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4242
4243 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4244 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4245 }
4246 }
4247 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4248
4249 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4250 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4251
4252 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4253 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4254
4255
4256 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4257 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4258 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4259 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4260
4261 static void
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4263 {
4264 XEvent event;
4265 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4266 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4267 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4268 ptrdiff_t i;
4269
4270 block_input ();
4271
4272 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4273 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4274 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4275 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4276 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4277 ev->format = 32;
4278
4279 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4280 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4281 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4282 into that array in the event. */
4283 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4284 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4285 break;
4286
4287 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4288 {
4289 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4290 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4291 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4292 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4293 scroll_bar_windows =
4294 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4295 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4296 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4297 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4298 }
4299
4300 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4301 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4302 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4303 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4304 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4305 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4306
4307 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4308 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4309 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4310 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4311 #endif
4312
4313 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4314 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4315 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4316 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4317 unblock_input ();
4318 }
4319
4320
4321 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4322 in *IEVENT. */
4323
4324 static void
4325 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4326 {
4327 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4328 Lisp_Object window;
4329 struct window *w;
4330
4331 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4332 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4333
4334 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4335
4336 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4337 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4338 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4339 #ifdef USE_GTK
4340 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4341 #else
4342 ievent->timestamp =
4343 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4344 #endif
4345 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4346 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4347 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4348 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4349 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4350 }
4351
4352
4353 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4354
4355 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4356
4357 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4358
4359
4360 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4361 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4362 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4363
4364 static void
4365 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4366 {
4367 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4368 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4369 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4370
4371 switch (cs->reason)
4372 {
4373 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4374 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4375 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4376 break;
4377
4378 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4379 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4380 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4381 break;
4382
4383 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4384 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4385 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4386 break;
4387
4388 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4389 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4390 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4391 break;
4392
4393 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4394 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4395 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4396 break;
4397
4398 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4399 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4400 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4401 break;
4402
4403 case XmCR_DRAG:
4404 {
4405 int slider_size;
4406
4407 /* Get the slider size. */
4408 block_input ();
4409 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4410 unblock_input ();
4411
4412 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4413 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4414 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4415 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4416 }
4417 break;
4418
4419 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4420 break;
4421 };
4422
4423 if (part >= 0)
4424 {
4425 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4426 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4427 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4428 }
4429 }
4430
4431 #elif defined USE_GTK
4432
4433 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4434 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4435
4436 static gboolean
4437 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4438 GtkScrollType scroll,
4439 gdouble value,
4440 gpointer user_data)
4441 {
4442 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4443 gdouble position;
4444 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4445 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4446 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4447
4448 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4449 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4450
4451
4452 switch (scroll)
4453 {
4454 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4455 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4456 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4457 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4458 {
4459 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4460 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4461 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4462 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4463 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4464 }
4465 break;
4466 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4467 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4468 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4469 break;
4470 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4471 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4472 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4473 break;
4474 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4475 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4476 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4477 break;
4478 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4479 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4480 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4481 break;
4482 }
4483
4484 if (part >= 0)
4485 {
4486 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4487 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4488 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4489 }
4490
4491 return FALSE;
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4495
4496 static gboolean
4497 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4498 GdkEventButton *event,
4499 gpointer user_data)
4500 {
4501 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4502 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4503 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4504 {
4505 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4506 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4507 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4508 }
4509
4510 return FALSE;
4511 }
4512
4513
4514 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4515
4516 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4517 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4518 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4519 the thumb is. */
4520
4521 static void
4522 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4523 {
4524 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4525 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4526 float shown;
4527 int whole, portion, height;
4528 int part;
4529
4530 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4531 block_input ();
4532 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4533 unblock_input ();
4534
4535 whole = 10000000;
4536 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4537
4538 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4539 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4540 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4541 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4542 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4543 bottom). */
4544 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4545 else
4546 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4547
4548 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4549 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4550 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4551 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4552 }
4553
4554
4555 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4556 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4557 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4558 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4559 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4560 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4561 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4562
4563 static void
4564 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4565 {
4566 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4567 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4568 int position = (long) call_data;
4569 Dimension height;
4570 int part;
4571
4572 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4573 block_input ();
4574 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4575 unblock_input ();
4576
4577 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4578 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4579
4580 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4581 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4582 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4583 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4584 else
4585 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4586
4587 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4588 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4589 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4590 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4591 }
4592
4593 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4594
4595 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4596
4597 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4598 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4599
4600 #ifdef USE_GTK
4601 static void
4602 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4603 {
4604 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4605
4606 block_input ();
4607 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4608 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4609 scroll_bar_name);
4610 unblock_input ();
4611 }
4612
4613 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4614
4615 static void
4616 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4617 {
4618 Window xwindow;
4619 Widget widget;
4620 Arg av[20];
4621 int ac = 0;
4622 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4623 unsigned long pixel;
4624
4625 block_input ();
4626
4627 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4628 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4629 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4630 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4632 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4633 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4634 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4635 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4636
4637 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4638 if (pixel != -1)
4639 {
4640 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4641 ++ac;
4642 }
4643
4644 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4645 if (pixel != -1)
4646 {
4647 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4648 ++ac;
4649 }
4650
4651 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4652 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4653
4654 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4655 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4656 (XtPointer) bar);
4657 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4658 (XtPointer) bar);
4659 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4660 (XtPointer) bar);
4661 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4662 (XtPointer) bar);
4663 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4664 (XtPointer) bar);
4665 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4666 (XtPointer) bar);
4667 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4668 (XtPointer) bar);
4669
4670 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4671 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4672
4673 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4674 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4675 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4676 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4677
4678 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4679
4680 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4681 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4682 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4683 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4684 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4685 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4686 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4687 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4688
4689 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4690 if (pixel != -1)
4691 {
4692 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4693 ++ac;
4694 }
4695
4696 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4697 if (pixel != -1)
4698 {
4699 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4700 ++ac;
4701 }
4702
4703 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4704
4705 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4706 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4707 {
4708 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4709 if (pixel != -1)
4710 {
4711 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4712 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4713 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4714 pixel = -1;
4715 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4716 }
4717 }
4718 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4719 {
4720 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4721 if (pixel != -1)
4722 {
4723 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4724 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4725 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4726 pixel = -1;
4727 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4728 }
4729 }
4730
4731 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4732 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4733 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4734 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4735 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4736 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4737 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4738 colors itself. */
4739 {
4740 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4741 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4742 ++ac;
4743 }
4744 else
4745 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4746 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4747 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4748 {
4749 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4750 the shadows. */
4751 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4752 ++ac;
4753
4754 /* Specify the colors. */
4755 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4756 if (pixel != -1)
4757 {
4758 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4759 ++ac;
4760 }
4761 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4762 if (pixel != -1)
4763 {
4764 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4765 ++ac;
4766 }
4767 }
4768 #endif
4769
4770 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4771 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4772
4773 {
4774 char const *initial = "";
4775 char const *val = initial;
4776 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4777 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4778 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4779 #endif
4780 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4781 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4782 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4783 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4784 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4785 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4786 }
4787 }
4788
4789 /* Define callbacks. */
4790 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4791 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4792 (XtPointer) bar);
4793
4794 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4795 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4796
4797 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4798
4799 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4800 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4801 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4802 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4803
4804 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4805 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4806 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4807 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4808
4809 unblock_input ();
4810 }
4811 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4812
4813
4814 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4815 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4816
4817 #ifdef USE_GTK
4818 static void
4819 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4820 {
4821 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4822 }
4823
4824 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4825 static void
4826 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4827 int whole)
4828 {
4829 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4830 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4831 float top, shown;
4832
4833 block_input ();
4834
4835 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4836
4837 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4838 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4839 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4840 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4841 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4842 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4843 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4844 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4845 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4846 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4847 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4848 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4849 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4850 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4851 whole += portion;
4852
4853 if (whole <= 0)
4854 top = 0, shown = 1;
4855 else
4856 {
4857 top = (float) position / whole;
4858 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4859 }
4860
4861 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4862 {
4863 int size, value;
4864
4865 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4866 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4867 value. */
4868 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4869 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4870 size = max (size, 1);
4871
4872 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4873 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4874 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4875
4876 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4877 }
4878 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4879
4880 if (whole == 0)
4881 top = 0, shown = 1;
4882 else
4883 {
4884 top = (float) position / whole;
4885 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4886 }
4887
4888 {
4889 float old_top, old_shown;
4890 Dimension height;
4891 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4892 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4893 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4894 XtNheight, &height,
4895 NULL);
4896
4897 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4898 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4899 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4900 else
4901 top = old_top;
4902 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4903 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4904
4905 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4906 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4907 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4908 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4909 {
4910 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4911 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4912 else
4913 {
4914 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4915 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4916 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4917
4918 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4919 }
4920 }
4921 }
4922 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4923
4924 unblock_input ();
4925 }
4926 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4927
4928 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4929
4930
4931 \f
4932 /************************************************************************
4933 Scroll bars, general
4934 ************************************************************************/
4935
4936 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4937 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4938 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4939 scroll bar. */
4940
4941 static struct scroll_bar *
4942 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4943 {
4944 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4945 struct scroll_bar *bar
4946 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4947 Lisp_Object barobj;
4948
4949 block_input ();
4950
4951 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4952 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4953 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4954 {
4955 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4956 unsigned long mask;
4957 Window window;
4958
4959 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4960 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4961 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4962
4963 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4964 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4965 | ExposureMask);
4966 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4967
4968 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4969
4970 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4971 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4972 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4973 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4974 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4975 left, top, width,
4976 window_box_height (w), False);
4977
4978 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4979 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4980 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4981 top,
4982 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4983 height,
4984 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4985 0,
4986 CopyFromParent,
4987 CopyFromParent,
4988 CopyFromParent,
4989 /* Attributes. */
4990 mask, &a);
4991 bar->x_window = window;
4992 }
4993 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4994
4995 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4996 bar->top = top;
4997 bar->left = left;
4998 bar->width = width;
4999 bar->height = height;
5000 bar->start = 0;
5001 bar->end = 0;
5002 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5003 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5004
5005 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5006 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5007 bar->prev = Qnil;
5008 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5009 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5010 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5011 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5012
5013 /* Map the window/widget. */
5014 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5015 {
5016 #ifdef USE_GTK
5017 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5018 bar->x_window,
5019 top,
5020 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5021 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5022 max (height, 1));
5023 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5024 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5025 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5026 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5027 top,
5028 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5029 max (height, 1), 0);
5030 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5031 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5032 }
5033 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5034 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5035 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5036
5037 unblock_input ();
5038 return bar;
5039 }
5040
5041
5042 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5043
5044 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5045
5046 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5047 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5048 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5049 events.)
5050
5051 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5052 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5053 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5054 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5055 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5056
5057 static void
5058 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5059 {
5060 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5061 Window w = bar->x_window;
5062 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5063 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5064
5065 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5066 if (! rebuild
5067 && start == bar->start
5068 && end == bar->end)
5069 return;
5070
5071 block_input ();
5072
5073 {
5074 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5075 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5076 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5077
5078 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5079 the distance between start and end. */
5080 {
5081 int length = end - start;
5082
5083 if (start < 0)
5084 start = 0;
5085 else if (start > top_range)
5086 start = top_range;
5087 end = start + length;
5088
5089 if (end < start)
5090 end = start;
5091 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5092 end = top_range;
5093 }
5094
5095 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5096 bar->start = start;
5097 bar->end = end;
5098
5099 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5100 if (end > top_range)
5101 end = top_range;
5102
5103 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5104 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5105 that many pixels tall. */
5106 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5107
5108 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5109 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5110 if (0 < start)
5111 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5112 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5113 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5114 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5115 inside_width, start,
5116 False);
5117
5118 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5119 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5120 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5121 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5122
5123 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5124 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5125 /* x, y, width, height */
5126 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5127 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5128 inside_width, end - start);
5129
5130 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5131 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5132 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5133 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5134
5135 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5136 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5137 if (end < inside_height)
5138 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5139 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5140 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5141 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5142 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5143 False);
5144
5145 }
5146
5147 unblock_input ();
5148 }
5149
5150 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5151
5152 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5153 nil. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5157 {
5158 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5159 block_input ();
5160
5161 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5162 #ifdef USE_GTK
5163 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5164 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5165 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5166 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5167 #else
5168 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5169 #endif
5170
5171 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5172 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5173
5174 unblock_input ();
5175 }
5176
5177
5178 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5179 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5180 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5181 create one. */
5182
5183 static void
5184 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5185 {
5186 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5187 Lisp_Object barobj;
5188 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5189 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5190 int window_y, window_height;
5191 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5192 int fringe_extended_p;
5193 #endif
5194
5195 /* Get window dimensions. */
5196 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5197 top = window_y;
5198 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5199 height = window_height;
5200
5201 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5202 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5203
5204 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5205 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5206 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5207 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5208 else
5209 sb_width = width;
5210
5211 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5212 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5213 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5214 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5215 else
5216 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5217 #else
5218 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5219 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5220 else
5221 sb_left = left;
5222 #endif
5223
5224 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5225 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5226 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5227 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5228 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5229 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5230 else
5231 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5232 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5233 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5234 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5235 #endif
5236
5237 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5238 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5239 {
5240 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5241 {
5242 block_input ();
5243 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5244 if (fringe_extended_p)
5245 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5246 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5247 else
5248 #endif
5249 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5250 left, top, width, height, False);
5251 unblock_input ();
5252 }
5253
5254 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5255 }
5256 else
5257 {
5258 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5259 unsigned int mask = 0;
5260
5261 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5262
5263 block_input ();
5264
5265 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5266 mask |= CWX;
5267 if (top != bar->top)
5268 mask |= CWY;
5269 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5270 mask |= CWWidth;
5271 if (height != bar->height)
5272 mask |= CWHeight;
5273
5274 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5275
5276 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5277 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5278 {
5279 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5280 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5281 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5282 {
5283 if (fringe_extended_p)
5284 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5285 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5286 else
5287 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5288 left, top, width, height, False);
5289 }
5290 #ifdef USE_GTK
5291 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5292 bar->x_window,
5293 top,
5294 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5295 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5296 max (height, 1));
5297 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5298 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5299 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5300 top,
5301 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5302 max (height, 1), 0);
5303 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5304 }
5305 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5306
5307 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5308 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5309 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5310 {
5311 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5312 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5313 height, False);
5314 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5315 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5316 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5317 height, False);
5318 }
5319
5320 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5321 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5322 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5323 example. */
5324 {
5325 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5326 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5327 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5328 {
5329 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5330 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5331 left + area_width - rest, top,
5332 rest, height, False);
5333 else
5334 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5335 left, top, rest, height, False);
5336 }
5337 }
5338
5339 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5340 if (mask)
5341 {
5342 XWindowChanges wc;
5343
5344 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5345 wc.y = top;
5346 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5347 wc.height = height;
5348 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5349 mask, &wc);
5350 }
5351
5352 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5353
5354 /* Remember new settings. */
5355 bar->left = sb_left;
5356 bar->top = top;
5357 bar->width = sb_width;
5358 bar->height = height;
5359
5360 unblock_input ();
5361 }
5362
5363 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5364 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5365
5366 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5367 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5368 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5369 dragged. */
5370 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5371 {
5372 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5373
5374 if (whole == 0)
5375 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5376 else
5377 {
5378 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5379 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5380 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5381 }
5382 }
5383 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5384
5385 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5386 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5387 }
5388
5389
5390 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5391 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5392 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5393 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5394 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5395 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5396 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5397
5398 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5399 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5400 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5401
5402 static void
5403 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5404 {
5405 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5406 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5407 {
5408 Lisp_Object bar;
5409 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5410 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5411 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5412 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5413 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5414 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5415 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5416 }
5417 }
5418
5419
5420 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5421 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5422
5423 static void
5424 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5425 {
5426 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5427 struct frame *f;
5428 Lisp_Object barobj;
5429
5430 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5431 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5432 emacs_abort ();
5433
5434 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5435
5436 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5437 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5438 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5439 {
5440 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5441 the lists. */
5442 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5443 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5444 return;
5445 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5446 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5447 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5448 else
5449 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5450 one or the other! */
5451 emacs_abort ();
5452 }
5453 else
5454 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5455
5456 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5457 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5458
5459 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5460 bar->prev = Qnil;
5461 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5462 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5463 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5464 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5465 }
5466
5467 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5468 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5469
5470 static void
5471 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5472 {
5473 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5474
5475 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5476
5477 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5478 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5479 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5480
5481 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5482 {
5483 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5484
5485 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5486
5487 next = b->next;
5488 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5489 }
5490
5491 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5492 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5493 }
5494
5495
5496 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5497 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5498 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5499
5500 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5501 mark bits. */
5502
5503 static void
5504 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5505 {
5506 Window w = bar->x_window;
5507 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5508 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5509 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5510
5511 block_input ();
5512
5513 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5514
5515 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5516 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5517 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5518 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5519
5520 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5521 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5522
5523 /* x, y, width, height */
5524 0, 0,
5525 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5526 bar->height - 1);
5527
5528 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5529 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5530 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5531 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5532
5533 unblock_input ();
5534
5535 }
5536 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5537
5538 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5539 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5540
5541 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5542 mark bits. */
5543
5544
5545 static void
5546 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5547 {
5548 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5549 emacs_abort ();
5550
5551 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5552 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5553 emacs_event->modifiers
5554 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5555 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5556 event->xbutton.state)
5557 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5558 ? up_modifier
5559 : down_modifier));
5560 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5561 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5562 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5563 {
5564 int top_range
5565 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5566 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5567
5568 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5569 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5570
5571 if (y < bar->start)
5572 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5573 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5574 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5575 else
5576 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5577
5578 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5579 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5580 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5581 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5582 {
5583 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5584 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5585
5586 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5587 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5588 }
5589 #endif
5590
5591 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5592 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5593 }
5594 }
5595
5596 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5597
5598 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5599
5600 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5601 mark bits. */
5602
5603 static void
5604 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5605 {
5606 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5607
5608 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5609
5610 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5611 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5612
5613 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5614 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5615 {
5616 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5617 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5618
5619 if (new_start != bar->start)
5620 {
5621 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5622
5623 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5624 }
5625 }
5626 }
5627
5628 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5629
5630 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5631 on the scroll bar. */
5632
5633 static void
5634 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5635 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5636 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5637 {
5638 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5639 Window w = bar->x_window;
5640 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5641 int win_x, win_y;
5642 Window dummy_window;
5643 int dummy_coord;
5644 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5645
5646 block_input ();
5647
5648 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5649 report that. */
5650 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5651
5652 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5653 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5654 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5655
5656 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5657 &win_x, &win_y,
5658
5659 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5660 &dummy_mask))
5661 ;
5662 else
5663 {
5664 int top_range
5665 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5666
5667 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5668
5669 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5670 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5671
5672 if (win_y < 0)
5673 win_y = 0;
5674 if (win_y > top_range)
5675 win_y = top_range;
5676
5677 *fp = f;
5678 *bar_window = bar->window;
5679
5680 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5681 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5682 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5683 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5684 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5685 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5686 else
5687 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5688
5689 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5690 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5691
5692 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5693 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5694 }
5695
5696 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5697
5698 unblock_input ();
5699 }
5700
5701
5702 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5703 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5704 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5705 redraw them. */
5706
5707 static void
5708 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5709 {
5710 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5711 Lisp_Object bar;
5712
5713 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5714 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5715 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5716 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5717 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5718 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5719 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5720 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5721 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5722 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5723 }
5724
5725 \f
5726 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5727
5728 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5729 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5730 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5731 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5732
5733 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5734 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5735
5736 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5737
5738 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5739 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5740
5741 static int temp_index;
5742 static short temp_buffer[100];
5743
5744 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5745 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5746 temp_index = 0; \
5747 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5748
5749 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5750 on a particular display. */
5751
5752 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5753
5754 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5755 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5756 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5757 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5758
5759 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5760
5761 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5762 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5763 do \
5764 { \
5765 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5766 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5767 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5768 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5769 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5770 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5771 } \
5772 while (0)
5773 #endif
5774
5775 enum
5776 {
5777 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5778 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5779 X_EVENT_DROP
5780 };
5781
5782 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5783 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5784 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5785
5786 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5787 this event further.
5788 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5789
5790 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5791 static int
5792 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5793 {
5794 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5795 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5796 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5797 was created. */
5798
5799 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5800 event->xclient.window);
5801
5802 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5803 }
5804 #endif
5805
5806 #ifdef USE_GTK
5807 static int current_count;
5808 static int current_finish;
5809 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5810
5811 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5812 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5813 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5814 static GdkFilterReturn
5815 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5816 {
5817 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5818
5819 block_input ();
5820 if (current_count >= 0)
5821 {
5822 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5823
5824 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5825
5826 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5827 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5828 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5829 so we do it here. */
5830 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5831 && dpyinfo
5832 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5833 {
5834 unblock_input ();
5835 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5836 }
5837 #endif
5838
5839 if (! dpyinfo)
5840 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5841 else
5842 current_count +=
5843 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5844 current_hold_quit);
5845 }
5846 else
5847 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5848
5849 unblock_input ();
5850
5851 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5852 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5853
5854 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5855 }
5856 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5857
5858
5859 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5860 enum xembed_message,
5861 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5862
5863 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5864
5865 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5866 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5867 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5868
5869 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5870
5871 static int
5872 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5873 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5874 {
5875 union {
5876 struct input_event ie;
5877 struct selection_input_event sie;
5878 } inev;
5879 int count = 0;
5880 int do_help = 0;
5881 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5882 struct frame *f = NULL;
5883 struct coding_system coding;
5884 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5885 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5886 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5887
5888 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5889
5890 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5891 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5892 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5893
5894 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5895 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5896
5897 switch (event.type)
5898 {
5899 case ClientMessage:
5900 {
5901 if (event.xclient.message_type
5902 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5903 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5904 {
5905 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5906 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5907 {
5908 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5909 could be the shell widget window
5910 if the frame has no title bar. */
5911 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5912 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5913 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5914 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5915 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5916 #endif
5917 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5918 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5919 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5920 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5921 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5922 needed.
5923
5924 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5925 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5926 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5927 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5928 Emacs. */
5929
5930 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5931 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5932 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5933 if (f)
5934 {
5935 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5936 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5937 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5938 x_catch_errors (d);
5939 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5940 /* The ICCCM says this is
5941 the only valid choice. */
5942 RevertToParent,
5943 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5944 /* This is needed to detect the error
5945 if there is an error. */
5946 XSync (d, False);
5947 x_uncatch_errors ();
5948 }
5949 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5950 #endif /* 0 */
5951 goto done;
5952 }
5953
5954 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5955 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5956 {
5957 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5958 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5959 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5960 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5961 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5962 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5963 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5964 session manager and one for this. */
5965 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5966 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5967 #endif
5968 {
5969 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5970 event.xclient.window);
5971 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5972 for a single Emacs process. */
5973 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5974 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5975 event.xclient.window,
5976 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5977 else if (f)
5978 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5979 event.xclient.window,
5980 0, 0);
5981 }
5982 goto done;
5983 }
5984
5985 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5986 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5987 {
5988 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5989 event.xclient.window);
5990 if (!f)
5991 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5992
5993 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5994 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5995 goto done;
5996 }
5997
5998 goto done;
5999 }
6000
6001 if (event.xclient.message_type
6002 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6003 {
6004 goto done;
6005 }
6006
6007 if (event.xclient.message_type
6008 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6009 {
6010 int new_x, new_y;
6011 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6012
6013 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6014 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6015
6016 if (f)
6017 {
6018 f->left_pos = new_x;
6019 f->top_pos = new_y;
6020 }
6021 goto done;
6022 }
6023
6024 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6025 if (event.xclient.message_type
6026 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6027 {
6028 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6029 if (f)
6030 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6031 &event, NULL);
6032 goto done;
6033 }
6034 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6035
6036 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6037 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6038 || (event.xclient.message_type
6039 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6040 {
6041 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6042 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6043 currently never do because we are interested in
6044 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6045 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6046 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6047 if (!f)
6048 goto OTHER;
6049 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6050 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6051 goto done;
6052 }
6053
6054 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6055 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6056 we construct an input_event. */
6057 if (event.xclient.message_type
6058 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6059 {
6060 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6061 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6062 goto done;
6063 }
6064 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6065
6066 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6067 if (event.xclient.message_type
6068 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6069 {
6070 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6071 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6072 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6073
6074 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6075 goto done;
6076 }
6077
6078 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6079
6080 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6081 if (!f)
6082 goto OTHER;
6083 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6084 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6085 }
6086 break;
6087
6088 case SelectionNotify:
6089 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6090 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6091 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6092 goto OTHER;
6093 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6094 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6095 break;
6096
6097 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6098 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6099 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6100 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6101 goto OTHER;
6102 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6103 {
6104 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6105
6106 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6107 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6108 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6109 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6110 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6111 }
6112 break;
6113
6114 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6115 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6117 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6118 goto OTHER;
6119 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6120 {
6121 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6122
6123 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6124 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6125 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6126 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6127 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6128 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6129 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6130 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6131 }
6132 break;
6133
6134 case PropertyNotify:
6135 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6136 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6137 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6138 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6139 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6140 {
6141 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6142 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6143 treat it as deiconified. */
6144 if (! f->async_iconified)
6145 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6146 f->async_visible = 1;
6147 f->async_iconified = 0;
6148 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6149 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6150 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6151 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6152 }
6153
6154 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6155 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6156 goto OTHER;
6157
6158 case ReparentNotify:
6159 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6160 if (f)
6161 {
6162 int x, y;
6163 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6164 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6165 f->left_pos = x;
6166 f->top_pos = y;
6167
6168 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6169 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6170 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6171
6172 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6173 }
6174 goto OTHER;
6175
6176 case Expose:
6177 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6178 if (f)
6179 {
6180 #ifdef USE_GTK
6181 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6182 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6183 event.xexpose.window,
6184 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6185 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6186 FALSE);
6187 #endif
6188 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6189 {
6190 f->async_visible = 1;
6191 f->async_iconified = 0;
6192 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6193 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6194 }
6195 else
6196 expose_frame (f,
6197 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6198 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6199 }
6200 else
6201 {
6202 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6203 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6204 #endif
6205 #if defined USE_LUCID
6206 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6207 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6208 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6209 {
6210 Widget widget
6211 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6212 if (widget)
6213 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6214 }
6215 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6216
6217 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6218 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6219 goto OTHER;
6220 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6221 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6222 event.xexpose.window);
6223
6224 if (bar)
6225 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6226 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6227 else
6228 goto OTHER;
6229 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6230 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6231 }
6232 break;
6233
6234 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6235 source area was obscured or not
6236 available. */
6237 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6238 if (f)
6239 {
6240 expose_frame (f,
6241 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6242 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6243 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6244 }
6245 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6246 else
6247 goto OTHER;
6248 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6249 break;
6250
6251 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6252 source area was completely
6253 available. */
6254 break;
6255
6256 case UnmapNotify:
6257 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6258 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6259 {
6260 tip_window = 0;
6261 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6262 }
6263
6264 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6265 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6266 the frame was deleted. */
6267 {
6268 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6269 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6270 display that won't ever be seen. */
6271 f->async_visible = 0;
6272 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6273 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6274 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6275 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6276 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6277 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6278 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6279 {
6280 f->async_iconified = 1;
6281
6282 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6283 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6284 }
6285 }
6286 goto OTHER;
6287
6288 case MapNotify:
6289 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6290 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6291 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6292 goto OTHER;
6293
6294 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6295 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6296 frame is visible. */
6297 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6298 if (f)
6299 {
6300 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6301 the frame's display structures.
6302 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6303 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6304 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6305 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6306 if (! f->async_iconified)
6307 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6308
6309 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6310 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6311 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6312 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6313
6314 f->async_visible = 1;
6315 f->async_iconified = 0;
6316 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6317
6318 if (f->iconified)
6319 {
6320 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6321 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6322 }
6323 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6324 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6325 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6326 to update the frame titles
6327 in case this is the second frame. */
6328 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6329
6330 #ifdef USE_GTK
6331 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6332 #endif
6333 }
6334 goto OTHER;
6335
6336 case KeyPress:
6337
6338 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6339 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6340
6341 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6342 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6343 if (popup_activated ())
6344 goto OTHER;
6345 #endif
6346
6347 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6348
6349 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6350 mouse highlighting. */
6351 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6352 && (f == 0
6353 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6354 {
6355 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6356 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6357 }
6358
6359 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6360 if (f == 0)
6361 {
6362 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6363 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6364 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6365 event.xkey.window);
6366 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6367 {
6368 widget = XtParent (widget);
6369 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6370 }
6371 }
6372 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6373
6374 if (f != 0)
6375 {
6376 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6377 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6378 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6379 his Emacs hang.
6380
6381 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6382 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6383 status_return even if the input is too long to
6384 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6385 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6386 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6387 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6388 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6389 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6390 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6391 int modifiers;
6392 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6393 Lisp_Object c;
6394
6395 #ifdef USE_GTK
6396 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6397 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6398 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6399 (see above). */
6400 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6401 #endif
6402
6403 event.xkey.state
6404 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6405 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6406 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6407
6408 /* This will have to go some day... */
6409
6410 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6411 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6412 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6413 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6414 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6415 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6416 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6417
6418 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6419 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6420 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6421 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6422 not it is combined with Meta. */
6423 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6424 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6425
6426 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6427 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6428 {
6429 Status status_return;
6430
6431 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6432 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6433 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6434 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6435 &status_return);
6436 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6437 {
6438 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6439 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6440 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6441 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6442 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6443 &status_return);
6444 }
6445 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6446 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6447 break;
6448 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6449 {
6450 keysym = NoSymbol;
6451 modifiers = 0;
6452 }
6453 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6454 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6455 emacs_abort ();
6456 }
6457 else
6458 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6459 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6460 &compose_status);
6461 #else
6462 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6463 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6464 &compose_status);
6465 #endif
6466
6467 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6468 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6469 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6470 break;
6471
6472 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6473 orig_keysym = keysym;
6474
6475 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6476 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6477 inev.ie.modifiers
6478 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6479 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6480
6481 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6482 translations to characters. */
6483 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6484 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6485 {
6486 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6487 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6488 goto done_keysym;
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6492 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6493 {
6494 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6495 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6496 else
6497 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6498 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6499 goto done_keysym;
6500 }
6501
6502 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6503 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6504 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6505 Vx_keysym_table,
6506 Qnil),
6507 NATNUMP (c)))
6508 {
6509 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6510 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6511 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6512 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6513 goto done_keysym;
6514 }
6515
6516 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6517 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6518 || keysym == XK_Delete
6519 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6520 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6521 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6522 #endif
6523 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6524 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6525 #ifdef HPUX
6526 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6527 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6528 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6529 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6530 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6540 #endif
6541 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6542 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6543 #endif
6544 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6545 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6546 #endif
6547 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6548 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6549 #endif
6550 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6551 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6552 #endif
6553 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6554 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6555 #endif
6556 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6557 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6558 #endif
6559 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6560 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6561 #endif
6562 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6563 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6564 #endif
6565 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6566 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6567 #endif
6568 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6569 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6570 #endif
6571 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6572 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6573 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6574 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6575 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6576 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6577 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6578 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6579 don't have real modifiers but
6580 should be treated similarly to
6581 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6582 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6583 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6584 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6585 #endif
6586 ))
6587 {
6588 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6589 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6590 key. */
6591 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6592 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6593 goto done_keysym;
6594 }
6595
6596 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6597 ptrdiff_t i;
6598 int nchars, len;
6599
6600 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6601 {
6602 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6603 nchars++;
6604 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6605 }
6606
6607 if (nchars < nbytes)
6608 {
6609 /* Decode the input data. */
6610
6611 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6612 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6613 we used just above and the locale. */
6614 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6615 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6616 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6617 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6618 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6619 gives us composition information. */
6620 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6621
6622 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6623 nbytes);
6624 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6625 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6626 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6627 nbytes = coding.produced;
6628 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6629 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6630 }
6631
6632 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6633 character events. */
6634 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6635 {
6636 int ch;
6637 if (nchars == nbytes)
6638 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6639 else
6640 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6641 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6642 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6643 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6644 inev.ie.code = ch;
6645 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6646 }
6647
6648 count += nchars;
6649
6650 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6651
6652 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6653 break;
6654 }
6655 }
6656 done_keysym:
6657 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6658 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6659 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6660 client. */
6661 break;
6662 #else
6663 goto OTHER;
6664 #endif
6665
6666 case KeyRelease:
6667 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6668 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6669 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6670 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6671 client. */
6672 break;
6673 #else
6674 goto OTHER;
6675 #endif
6676
6677 case EnterNotify:
6678 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6679 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6680
6681 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6682
6683 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6684 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6685
6686 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6687 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6688 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6689 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6690 #ifdef USE_GTK
6691 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6692 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6693 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6694 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6695 #endif
6696 goto OTHER;
6697
6698 case FocusIn:
6699 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6700 goto OTHER;
6701
6702 case LeaveNotify:
6703 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6704 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6705
6706 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6707 if (f)
6708 {
6709 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6710 {
6711 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6712 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6713 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6714 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6715 }
6716
6717 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6718 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6719 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6720 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6721 if (any_help_event_p)
6722 do_help = -1;
6723 }
6724 #ifdef USE_GTK
6725 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6726 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6727 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6728 #endif
6729 goto OTHER;
6730
6731 case FocusOut:
6732 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6733 goto OTHER;
6734
6735 case MotionNotify:
6736 {
6737 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6738 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6739 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6740
6741 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6742 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6743 f = last_mouse_frame;
6744 else
6745 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6746
6747 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6748 {
6749 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6750 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6751 }
6752
6753 #ifdef USE_GTK
6754 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6755 f = 0;
6756 #endif
6757 if (f)
6758 {
6759
6760 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6761 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6762 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6763 {
6764 Lisp_Object window;
6765
6766 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6767 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6768 0, 0);
6769
6770 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6771 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6772 will be selected only when it is active. */
6773 if (WINDOWP (window)
6774 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6775 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6776 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6777 create event iff we don't leave the
6778 selected frame. */
6779 && (focus_follows_mouse
6780 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6781 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6782 {
6783 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6784 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6785 }
6786
6787 last_window=window;
6788 }
6789 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6790 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6791 }
6792 else
6793 {
6794 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6795 struct scroll_bar *bar
6796 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6797 event.xmotion.window);
6798
6799 if (bar)
6800 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6801 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6802
6803 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6804 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6805 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6806 }
6807
6808 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6809 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6810 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6811 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6812 do_help = 1;
6813 goto OTHER;
6814 }
6815
6816 case ConfigureNotify:
6817 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6818 #ifdef USE_GTK
6819 if (!f
6820 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6821 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6822 {
6823 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6824 event.xconfigure.height);
6825 f = 0;
6826 }
6827 #endif
6828 if (f)
6829 {
6830 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6831 #ifndef USE_GTK
6832 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6833 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6834
6835 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6836 is called by the code that handles resizing
6837 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6838
6839 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6840 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6841 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6842 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6843 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6844 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6845 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6846 {
6847 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6848 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6849 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6850 }
6851
6852 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6853 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6854 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6855 #endif
6856
6857 #ifdef USE_GTK
6858 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6859 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6860 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6861 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6862 #endif
6863 {
6864 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6865 }
6866
6867 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6868 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6869 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6870 #endif
6871
6872 }
6873 goto OTHER;
6874
6875 case ButtonRelease:
6876 case ButtonPress:
6877 {
6878 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6879 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6880 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6881
6882 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6883 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6884 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6885
6886 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6887 && last_mouse_frame
6888 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6889 f = last_mouse_frame;
6890 else
6891 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6892
6893 #ifdef USE_GTK
6894 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6895 f = 0;
6896 #endif
6897 if (f)
6898 {
6899 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6900 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6901 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6902 {
6903 Lisp_Object window;
6904 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6905 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6906
6907 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6908 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6909
6910 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6911 {
6912 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6913 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6914 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6915 event.xbutton.state));
6916 }
6917 }
6918
6919 if (!tool_bar_p)
6920 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6921 if (! popup_activated ())
6922 #endif
6923 {
6924 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6925 {
6926 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6927 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6928 {
6929 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6930 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6931 }
6932 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6933 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6934 }
6935 else
6936 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6937 }
6938 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6939 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6940 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6941 }
6942 else
6943 {
6944 struct scroll_bar *bar
6945 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6946 event.xbutton.window);
6947
6948 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6949 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6950 scroll bars. */
6951 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6952 {
6953 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6954 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6955 }
6956 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6957 if (bar)
6958 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6959 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6960 }
6961
6962 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6963 {
6964 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6965 last_mouse_frame = f;
6966
6967 if (!tool_bar_p)
6968 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6969 }
6970 else
6971 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6972
6973 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6974 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6975 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6976 if (f != 0)
6977 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6978
6979 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6980 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6981 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6982 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6983 Instead, save it away
6984 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6985 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6986 if (! popup_activated ()
6987 #ifdef USE_GTK
6988 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6989 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6990 #endif
6991 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6992 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6993 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6994 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6995 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6996 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6997 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6998 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6999 {
7000 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7001 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7002 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7003 }
7004 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7005 {
7006 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7007 goto OTHER;
7008 }
7009 else
7010 goto OTHER;
7011 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7012 }
7013 break;
7014
7015 case CirculateNotify:
7016 goto OTHER;
7017
7018 case CirculateRequest:
7019 goto OTHER;
7020
7021 case VisibilityNotify:
7022 goto OTHER;
7023
7024 case MappingNotify:
7025 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7026 local cache. */
7027 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7028 {
7029 case MappingModifier:
7030 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7031 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7032 case MappingKeyboard:
7033 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7034 }
7035 goto OTHER;
7036
7037 case DestroyNotify:
7038 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7039 break;
7040
7041 default:
7042 OTHER:
7043 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7044 block_input ();
7045 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7046 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7047 unblock_input ();
7048 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7049 break;
7050 }
7051
7052 done:
7053 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7054 {
7055 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7056 count++;
7057 }
7058
7059 if (do_help
7060 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7061 {
7062 Lisp_Object frame;
7063
7064 if (f)
7065 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7066 else
7067 frame = Qnil;
7068
7069 if (do_help > 0)
7070 {
7071 any_help_event_p = 1;
7072 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7073 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7074 }
7075 else
7076 {
7077 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7078 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7079 }
7080 count++;
7081 }
7082
7083 SAFE_FREE ();
7084 *eventptr = event;
7085 return count;
7086 }
7087
7088 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7089
7090 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7091 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7092 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7093
7094 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7095 int
7096 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7097 {
7098 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7099 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7100
7101 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7102
7103 if (dpyinfo)
7104 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7105
7106 return finish;
7107 }
7108 #endif
7109
7110
7111 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7112 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7113
7114 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7115 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7116 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7117 C chars). */
7118
7119 static int
7120 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7121 {
7122 int count = 0;
7123 int event_found = 0;
7124
7125 block_input ();
7126
7127 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7128 input_signal_count++;
7129
7130 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7131 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7132 {
7133 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7134 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7135 }
7136
7137 #ifndef USE_GTK
7138 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7139 {
7140 int finish;
7141 XEvent event;
7142
7143 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7144
7145 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7146 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7147 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7148 continue;
7149 #endif
7150 event_found = 1;
7151
7152 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7153 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7154
7155 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7156 goto out;
7157 }
7158
7159 out:;
7160
7161 #else /* USE_GTK */
7162
7163 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7164 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7165 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7166 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7167
7168 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7169 from all displays. */
7170
7171 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7172 {
7173 current_count = count;
7174 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7175
7176 gtk_main_iteration ();
7177
7178 count = current_count;
7179 current_count = -1;
7180 current_hold_quit = 0;
7181
7182 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7183 break;
7184 }
7185 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7186
7187 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7188 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7189 if (! event_found)
7190 {
7191 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7192 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7193 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7194 x_noop_count++;
7195 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7196 {
7197 x_noop_count=0;
7198
7199 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7200 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7201
7202 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7203
7204 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7205 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7206 }
7207 }
7208
7209 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7210 raise it now. */
7211 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7212 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7213 {
7214 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7215 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7216 }
7217
7218 unblock_input ();
7219
7220 return count;
7221 }
7222
7223
7224
7225 \f
7226 /***********************************************************************
7227 Text Cursor
7228 ***********************************************************************/
7229
7230 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7231 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7232
7233 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7234 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7235 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7236
7237 static void
7238 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7239 {
7240 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7241 XRectangle clip_rect;
7242 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7243
7244 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7245
7246 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7247 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7248 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7249 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7250 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7251
7252 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7253 }
7254
7255
7256 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7257
7258 static void
7259 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7260 {
7261 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7262 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7263 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7264 int x, y, wd, h;
7265 XGCValues xgcv;
7266 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7267 GC gc;
7268
7269 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7270 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7271 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7272 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7273 return;
7274
7275 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7276 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7277 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7278
7279 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7280 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7281 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7282 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7283 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7284 else
7285 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7286 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7287 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7288
7289 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7290 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7291 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7292 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7293 }
7294
7295
7296 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7297
7298 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7299 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7300 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7301 --gerd. */
7302
7303 static void
7304 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7305 {
7306 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7307 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7308
7309 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7310 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7311 and mini-buffer. */
7312 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7313 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7314 return;
7315
7316 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7317 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7318 the bar might not be in the window. */
7319 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7320 {
7321 struct glyph_row *r;
7322 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7323 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7324 }
7325 else
7326 {
7327 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7328 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7329 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7330 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7331 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7332 XGCValues xgcv;
7333
7334 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7335 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7336 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7337 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7338 that the glyph is legible. */
7339 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7340 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7341 else
7342 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7343 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7344
7345 if (gc)
7346 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7347 else
7348 {
7349 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7350 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7351 }
7352
7353 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7354
7355 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7356 {
7357 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7358
7359 if (width < 0)
7360 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7361 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7362
7363 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7364
7365 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7366 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7367 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7368 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7369
7370 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7371 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7372 width, row->height);
7373 }
7374 else
7375 {
7376 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7377
7378 if (width < 0)
7379 width = row->height;
7380
7381 width = min (row->height, width);
7382
7383 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7384 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7385
7386 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7387 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7388 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7389 row->height - width),
7390 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7391 }
7392
7393 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7394 }
7395 }
7396
7397
7398 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7399
7400 static void
7401 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7402 {
7403 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7404 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7405 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7406 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7407 }
7408
7409
7410 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7411
7412 static void
7413 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7414 {
7415 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7416 x, y, width, height, False);
7417 #ifdef USE_GTK
7418 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7419 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7420 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7421 #endif
7422 }
7423
7424
7425 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7426
7427 static void
7428 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7429 {
7430 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7431
7432 if (on_p)
7433 {
7434 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7435 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7436
7437 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7438 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7439 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7440 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7441 {
7442 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7443 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7444 }
7445 else
7446 {
7447 switch (cursor_type)
7448 {
7449 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7450 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7451 break;
7452
7453 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7454 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7455 break;
7456
7457 case BAR_CURSOR:
7458 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7459 break;
7460
7461 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7462 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7463 break;
7464
7465 case NO_CURSOR:
7466 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7467 break;
7468
7469 default:
7470 emacs_abort ();
7471 }
7472 }
7473
7474 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7475 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7476 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7477 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7478 #endif
7479 }
7480
7481 #ifndef XFlush
7482 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7483 #endif
7484 }
7485
7486 \f
7487 /* Icons. */
7488
7489 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7490
7491 int
7492 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7493 {
7494 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7495
7496 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7497 return 1;
7498
7499 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7500 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7501 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7502 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7503
7504 if (STRINGP (file))
7505 {
7506 #ifdef USE_GTK
7507 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7508 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7509 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7510 return 0;
7511 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7512 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7513 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7514 }
7515 else
7516 {
7517 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7518 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7519 {
7520 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7521
7522 #ifdef USE_GTK
7523
7524 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7525 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7526 return 0;
7527
7528 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7529
7530 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7531 if (rc != -1)
7532 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7533
7534 #endif
7535
7536 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7537 if (rc == -1)
7538 {
7539 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7540 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7541 if (rc == -1)
7542 return 1;
7543
7544 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7545 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7550 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7551 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7552 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7553 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7554
7555 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7556 }
7557
7558 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7559 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7560
7561 return 0;
7562 }
7563
7564
7565 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7566 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7567
7568 int
7569 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7570 {
7571 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7572 return 1;
7573
7574 {
7575 XTextProperty text;
7576 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7577 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7578 text.format = 8;
7579 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7580 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7581 }
7582
7583 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7584 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7585 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7586 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7587
7588 return 0;
7589 }
7590 \f
7591 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7592
7593 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7594 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7595
7596 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7597 be called from a signal handler.
7598 */
7599
7600 struct x_error_message_stack {
7601 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7602 Display *dpy;
7603 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7604 };
7605 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7606
7607 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7608 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7609 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7610
7611 static void
7612 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7613 {
7614 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7615 x_error_message->string,
7616 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7617 }
7618
7619 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7620 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7621 operating on.
7622
7623 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7624 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7625 stored in *x_error_message.
7626
7627 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7628 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7629
7630 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7631
7632 void
7633 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7634 {
7635 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7636
7637 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7638 XSync (dpy, False);
7639
7640 data->dpy = dpy;
7641 data->string[0] = 0;
7642 data->prev = x_error_message;
7643 x_error_message = data;
7644 }
7645
7646 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7647 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7648
7649 void
7650 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7651 {
7652 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7653
7654 block_input ();
7655
7656 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7657 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7658 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7659 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7660
7661 tmp = x_error_message;
7662 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7663 xfree (tmp);
7664 unblock_input ();
7665 }
7666
7667 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7668 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7669 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7670
7671 void
7672 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7673 {
7674 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7675 XSync (dpy, False);
7676
7677 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7678 {
7679 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7680 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7681 x_uncatch_errors ();
7682 error (format, string);
7683 }
7684 }
7685
7686 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7687 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7688
7689 int
7690 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7691 {
7692 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7693 XSync (dpy, False);
7694
7695 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7696 }
7697
7698 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7699
7700 void
7701 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7702 {
7703 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7704 }
7705
7706 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7707 * idea. --lorentey */
7708 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7709
7710 void
7711 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7712 {
7713 while (x_error_message)
7714 x_uncatch_errors ();
7715 }
7716 #endif
7717
7718 #if 0
7719 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7720 x_trace_wire (void)
7721 {
7722 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7723 }
7724 #endif /* ! 0 */
7725
7726 \f
7727 /************************************************************************
7728 Handling X errors
7729 ************************************************************************/
7730
7731 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7732
7733 static char *error_msg;
7734
7735 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7736 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7737
7738 static void
7739 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7740 {
7741 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7742 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7743 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7744
7745 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7746 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7747
7748 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7749 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7750
7751 if (dpyinfo)
7752 {
7753 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7754 frame on it. */
7755 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7756 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7757 }
7758
7759 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7760 that are on the dead display. */
7761 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7762 {
7763 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7764 minibuf_frame
7765 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7766 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7767 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7768 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7769 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7770 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7771 }
7772
7773 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7774 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7775 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7776 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7777 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7778 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7779 {
7780 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7781 trying to find a replacement. */
7782 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7783 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7784 }
7785
7786 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7787 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7788 if (dpyinfo)
7789 {
7790 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7791 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7792 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7793 #ifdef USE_GTK
7794 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7795 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7796 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7797 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7798 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7799 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7800 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7801 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7802 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7803 error_msg);
7804 emacs_abort ();
7805 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7806
7807 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7808 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7809
7810 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7811 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7812 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7813 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7814 emacs_abort ();
7815
7816 {
7817 Lisp_Object tmp;
7818 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7819 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7820 }
7821 }
7822
7823 if (terminal_list == 0)
7824 {
7825 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7826 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7827 /* NOTREACHED */
7828 }
7829
7830 totally_unblock_input ();
7831
7832 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7833 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7834
7835 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7836 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7837
7838 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7839 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7840 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7841 error ("%s", error_msg);
7842 }
7843
7844 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7845 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7846 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7847
7848 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7849 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7850
7851 static int
7852 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7853 {
7854 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7855 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7856 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7857 && event->minor_code == 0)
7858 {
7859 return 0;
7860 }
7861 #endif
7862
7863 if (x_error_message)
7864 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7865 else
7866 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7867 return 0;
7868 }
7869
7870 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7871 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7872 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7873
7874 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7875
7876 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7877 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7878
7879 static void NO_INLINE
7880 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7881 {
7882 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7883
7884 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7885 or colors that are not defined. */
7886
7887 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7888 return;
7889
7890 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7891 original error handler. */
7892
7893 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7894 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7895 buf, event->request_code);
7896 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7897 }
7898
7899
7900 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7901 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7902 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7903
7904 static int
7905 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7906 {
7907 char buf[256];
7908
7909 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7910 DisplayString (display));
7911 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7912 return 0;
7913 }
7914 \f
7915 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7916
7917 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7918 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7919 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7920 FONT-OBJECT. */
7921
7922 Lisp_Object
7923 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7924 {
7925 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7926
7927 if (fontset < 0)
7928 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7929 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7930 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7931 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7932 do. */
7933 return font_object;
7934
7935 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7936 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7937 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7938 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7939 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7940
7941 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7942
7943 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7944 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7945 {
7946 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7947 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7948 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7949 }
7950 else
7951 {
7952 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7953 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7954 }
7955
7956 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7957 {
7958 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7959 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7960 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7961 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7962 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7963 }
7964
7965 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7966 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7967 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7968 {
7969 block_input ();
7970 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7971 unblock_input ();
7972 }
7973 #endif
7974
7975 return font_object;
7976 }
7977
7978 \f
7979 /***********************************************************************
7980 X Input Methods
7981 ***********************************************************************/
7982
7983 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7984
7985 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7986
7987 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7988 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7989 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7990
7991 static void
7992 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7993 {
7994 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7995 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7996
7997 block_input ();
7998
7999 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8000 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8001 {
8002 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8003 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8004 {
8005 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8006 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8007 }
8008 }
8009
8010 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8011 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8012 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8013 unblock_input ();
8014 }
8015
8016 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8017
8018 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8019 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8020 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8021 #endif
8022
8023 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8024 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8025
8026 static void
8027 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8028 {
8029 XIM xim;
8030
8031 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8032 if (use_xim)
8033 {
8034 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8035 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8036 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8037 emacs_class);
8038 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8039
8040 if (xim)
8041 {
8042 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8043 XIMCallback destroy;
8044 #endif
8045
8046 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8047 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8048
8049 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8050 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8051 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8052 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8053 #endif
8054 }
8055 }
8056
8057 else
8058 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8059 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8060 }
8061
8062
8063 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8064
8065 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8066 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8067 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8068 when the callback was registered. */
8069
8070 static void
8071 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8072 {
8073 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8074 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8075
8076 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8077 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8078 return;
8079
8080 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8081
8082 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8083 as they have no XIC. */
8084 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8085 {
8086 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8087
8088 block_input ();
8089 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8090 {
8091 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8092
8093 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8094 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8095 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8096 {
8097 create_frame_xic (f);
8098 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8099 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8100 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8101 {
8102 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8103 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8104 }
8105 }
8106 }
8107
8108 unblock_input ();
8109 }
8110 }
8111
8112 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8113
8114
8115 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8116 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8117 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8118 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8119
8120 static void
8121 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8122 {
8123 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8124 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8125 if (use_xim)
8126 {
8127 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8128 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8129 ptrdiff_t len;
8130
8131 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8132 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8133 len = strlen (resource_name);
8134 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8135 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8136 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8137 resource_name, emacs_class,
8138 xim_instantiate_callback,
8139 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8140 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8141 least, hence the configure test. */
8142 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8143 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8144 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8145 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8146 }
8147 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8148 }
8149
8150
8151 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8152
8153 static void
8154 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8155 {
8156 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8157 if (use_xim)
8158 {
8159 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8160 if (dpyinfo->display)
8161 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8162 NULL, emacs_class,
8163 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8164 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8165 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8166 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8167 if (dpyinfo->display)
8168 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8169 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8170 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8171 }
8172 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8173 }
8174
8175 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8176
8177
8178 \f
8179 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8180 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8181
8182 static void
8183 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8184 {
8185 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8186
8187 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8188 is already for the top-left corner. */
8189 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8190 return;
8191
8192 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8193 position that fits on the screen. */
8194 if (flags & XNegative)
8195 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8196 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8197
8198 {
8199 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8200
8201 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8202 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8203 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8204
8205 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8206 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8207 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8208 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8209 is right, though.
8210
8211 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8212 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8213
8214 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8215 #endif
8216
8217 if (flags & YNegative)
8218 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8219 - height + f->top_pos;
8220 }
8221
8222 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8223 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8224 so the flags should correspond. */
8225 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8226 }
8227
8228 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8229 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8230 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8231 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8232 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8233
8234 void
8235 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8236 {
8237 int modified_top, modified_left;
8238
8239 if (change_gravity > 0)
8240 {
8241 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8242 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8243
8244 f->top_pos = yoff;
8245 f->left_pos = xoff;
8246 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8247 if (xoff < 0)
8248 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8249 if (yoff < 0)
8250 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8251 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8252 }
8253 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8254
8255 block_input ();
8256 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8257
8258 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8259 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8260
8261 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8262 {
8263 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8264 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8265 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8266 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8267 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8268 }
8269
8270 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8271 modified_left, modified_top);
8272
8273 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8274 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8275 ? 1 : 0);
8276
8277 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8278 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8279 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8280 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8281 of the frame.
8282
8283 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8284 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8285 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8286
8287 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8288 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8289 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8290 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8291 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8292 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8293
8294 unblock_input ();
8295 }
8296
8297 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8298 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8299 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8300 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8301 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8302
8303 static int
8304 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8305 {
8306 Atom actual_type;
8307 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8308 int i, rc, actual_format;
8309 Window wmcheck_window;
8310 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8311 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8312 long max_len = 65536;
8313 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8314 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8315 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8316
8317 block_input ();
8318
8319 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8320 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8321 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8322 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8323 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8324 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8325
8326 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8327 {
8328 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8329 x_uncatch_errors ();
8330 unblock_input ();
8331 return 0;
8332 }
8333
8334 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8335 XFree (tmp_data);
8336
8337 /* Check if window exists. */
8338 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8339 x_sync (f);
8340 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8341 {
8342 x_uncatch_errors ();
8343 unblock_input ();
8344 return 0;
8345 }
8346
8347 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8348 {
8349 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8350 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8351 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8352 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8353 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8354 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8355
8356 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8357 tmp_data = NULL;
8358 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8359 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8360 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8361 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8362 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8363
8364 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8365 {
8366 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8367 x_uncatch_errors ();
8368 unblock_input ();
8369 return 0;
8370 }
8371
8372 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8373 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8374 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8375 }
8376
8377 rc = 0;
8378
8379 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8380 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8381
8382 x_uncatch_errors ();
8383 unblock_input ();
8384
8385 return rc;
8386 }
8387
8388 static void
8389 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8390 {
8391 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8392
8393 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8394 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8395 make_number (32),
8396 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8397 Fcons
8398 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8399 Fcons
8400 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8401 value != 0
8402 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8403 : Qnil)));
8404 }
8405
8406 void
8407 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8408 {
8409 Lisp_Object frame;
8410 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8411
8412 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8413
8414 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8415 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8416 }
8417
8418 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8419 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8420 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8421
8422 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8423
8424 static int
8425 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8426 Window window,
8427 int *size_state,
8428 int *sticky)
8429 {
8430 Atom actual_type;
8431 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8432 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8434 long max_len = 65536;
8435 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8436 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8437 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8438
8439 *sticky = 0;
8440 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8441
8442 block_input ();
8443 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8444 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8445 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8446 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8447 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8448
8449 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8450 {
8451 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8452 x_uncatch_errors ();
8453 unblock_input ();
8454 return ! f->iconified;
8455 }
8456
8457 x_uncatch_errors ();
8458
8459 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8460 {
8461 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8462 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8463 {
8464 is_hidden = 1;
8465 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8466 }
8467 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8468 {
8469 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8470 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8471 else
8472 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8473 }
8474 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8475 {
8476 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8477 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8478 else
8479 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8480 }
8481 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8482 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8483 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8484 *sticky = 1;
8485 }
8486
8487 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8488 unblock_input ();
8489 return ! is_hidden;
8490 }
8491
8492 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8493
8494 static int
8495 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8496 {
8497 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8498 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8499 int cur, dummy;
8500
8501 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8502
8503 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8504 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8505 if (!have_net_atom)
8506 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8507
8508 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8509 {
8510 Lisp_Object frame;
8511
8512 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8513
8514 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8515 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8516 are sent at once. */
8517 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8518 {
8519 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8520 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8521 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8522 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8523 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8524 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8525 break;
8526 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8527 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8528 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8529 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8530 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8531 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8532 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8533 break;
8534 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8535 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8536 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8537 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8538 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8539 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8540 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8541 break;
8542 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8543 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8544 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8545 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8546 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8547 break;
8548 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8549 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8550 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8551 else
8552 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8553 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8554 }
8555
8556 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8557
8558 }
8559
8560 return have_net_atom;
8561 }
8562
8563 static void
8564 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8565 {
8566 if (f->async_visible)
8567 {
8568 block_input ();
8569 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8570 x_sync (f);
8571 unblock_input ();
8572 }
8573 }
8574
8575
8576 static int
8577 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8578 {
8579 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8580 Lisp_Object lval;
8581 int sticky = 0;
8582 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8583
8584 lval = Qnil;
8585 switch (value)
8586 {
8587 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8588 lval = Qfullwidth;
8589 break;
8590 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8591 lval = Qfullheight;
8592 break;
8593 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8594 lval = Qfullboth;
8595 break;
8596 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8597 lval = Qmaximized;
8598 break;
8599 }
8600
8601 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8602 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8603
8604 return not_hidden;
8605 }
8606
8607 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8608 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8609 static void
8610 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8611 {
8612 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8613 return;
8614
8615 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8616 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8617
8618 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8619 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8620 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8621
8622 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8623 {
8624 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8625 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8626
8627 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8628 {
8629 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8630 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8631 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8632 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8633 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8634 break;
8635 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8636 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8637 break;
8638 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8639 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8640 }
8641
8642 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8643 width, height);
8644 }
8645 }
8646
8647 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8648 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8649 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8650 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8651 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8652 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8653 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8654
8655 static void
8656 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8657 {
8658 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8659
8660 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8661 window manager window around the frame. */
8662
8663 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8664
8665 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8666 {
8667 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8668
8669 int adjusted_left;
8670 int adjusted_top;
8671
8672 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8673 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8674 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8675
8676 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8677
8678 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8679 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8680
8681 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8682 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8683
8684 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8685 }
8686 else
8687 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8688 frame's position. */
8689
8690 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8691 }
8692
8693
8694 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8695 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8696 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8697 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8698 of an exact comparison. */
8699
8700 static void
8701 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8702 {
8703 int count = 0;
8704
8705 while (count++ < 50)
8706 {
8707 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8708
8709 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8710 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8711 loop. */
8712
8713 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8714 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8715
8716 if (fuzzy)
8717 {
8718 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8719 pixels. */
8720
8721 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8722 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8723 return;
8724 }
8725 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8726 return;
8727 }
8728
8729 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8730 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8731
8732 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8733 }
8734
8735
8736 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8737 void
8738 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8739 {
8740 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8741
8742 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8743 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8744 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8745
8746 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8747 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8748
8749 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8750 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8751 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8752 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8753
8754 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8755 {
8756 pending_signals = 1;
8757 totally_unblock_input ();
8758 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8759 block_input ();
8760 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8761
8762 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8763 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8764
8765 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8766 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8767 break;
8768
8769 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8770 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8771 break; /* Timeout */
8772 }
8773 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8774 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8775 }
8776
8777
8778 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8779 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8780 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8781 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8782
8783 static void
8784 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8785 {
8786 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8787
8788 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8789 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8790 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8791 ? 0
8792 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8793
8794 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8795
8796 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8797 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8798 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8799 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8800
8801 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8802 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8803 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8804 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8805
8806
8807 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8808 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8809 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8810 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8811 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8812
8813 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8814 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8815 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8816 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8817
8818 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8819 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8820 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8821 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8822 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8823
8824 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8825 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8826
8827 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8828 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8829 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8830 if (f->async_visible)
8831 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8832 else
8833 {
8834 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8835 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8836 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8837 x_sync (f);
8838 }
8839 }
8840
8841
8842 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8843 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8844 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8845 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8846
8847 void
8848 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8849 {
8850 block_input ();
8851
8852 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8853 {
8854 int r, c;
8855
8856 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8857 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8858 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8859 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8860 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8861 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8862 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8863 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8864 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8865 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8866 is however. */
8867 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8868 #endif
8869 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8870 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8871 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8872 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8873 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8874 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8875 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8876 }
8877
8878 #ifdef USE_GTK
8879 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8880 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8881 else
8882 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8883 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8884
8885 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8886
8887 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8888
8889 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8890 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8891
8892 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8893 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8894 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8895 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8896 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8897
8898 unblock_input ();
8899 }
8900 \f
8901 /* Mouse warping. */
8902
8903 void
8904 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8905 {
8906 int pix_x, pix_y;
8907
8908 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8909 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8910
8911 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8912 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8913
8914 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8915 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8916
8917 block_input ();
8918
8919 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8920 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8921 unblock_input ();
8922 }
8923
8924 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8925
8926 void
8927 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8928 {
8929 block_input ();
8930
8931 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8932 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8933 unblock_input ();
8934 }
8935 \f
8936 /* Raise frame F. */
8937
8938 void
8939 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8940 {
8941 block_input ();
8942 if (f->async_visible)
8943 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8944
8945 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8946 unblock_input ();
8947 }
8948
8949 /* Lower frame F. */
8950
8951 static void
8952 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8953 {
8954 if (f->async_visible)
8955 {
8956 block_input ();
8957 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8958 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8959 unblock_input ();
8960 }
8961 }
8962
8963 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8964
8965 void
8966 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8967 {
8968 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8969 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8970 if (f->async_visible)
8971 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8972 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8973 }
8974
8975 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8976
8977 void
8978 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8979 {
8980 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8981 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8982
8983 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8984 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8985 {
8986 Lisp_Object frame;
8987 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8988 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8989 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8990 make_number (32),
8991 Fcons (make_number (1),
8992 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8993 Qnil)));
8994 }
8995 }
8996
8997 static void
8998 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8999 {
9000 if (raise_flag)
9001 x_raise_frame (f);
9002 else
9003 x_lower_frame (f);
9004 }
9005 \f
9006 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9007
9008 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9009
9010 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9011
9012 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9013
9014 static void
9015 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9016 {
9017 unsigned long data[2];
9018 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9019
9020 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9021 data[1] = flags;
9022
9023 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9024 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9025 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9026 }
9027 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9028
9029 static void
9030 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9031 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9032 {
9033 XEvent event;
9034
9035 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9036 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9037 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9038 event.xclient.format = 32;
9039 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9040 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9041 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9042 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9043 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9044
9045 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9046 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9047 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9048 }
9049 \f
9050 /* Change of visibility. */
9051
9052 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9053 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9054 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9055 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9056 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9057 finishes with it. */
9058
9059 void
9060 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9061 {
9062 Lisp_Object type;
9063 int original_top, original_left;
9064 int retry_count = 2;
9065
9066 retry:
9067
9068 block_input ();
9069
9070 type = x_icon_type (f);
9071 if (!NILP (type))
9072 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9073
9074 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9075 {
9076 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9077 call x_set_offset a second time
9078 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9079 before the window gets really visible. */
9080 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9081 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9082 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9083 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9084
9085 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9086
9087 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9088 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9089 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9090 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9091 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9092 else
9093 {
9094 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9095 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9096 }
9097 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9098 #ifdef USE_GTK
9099 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9100 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9101 #else
9102 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9103 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9104 else
9105 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9106 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9107 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9108 }
9109
9110 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9111
9112 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9113 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9114 so that incoming events are handled. */
9115 {
9116 Lisp_Object frame;
9117 int count;
9118 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9119 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9120 will set it when they are handled. */
9121 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9122
9123 original_left = f->left_pos;
9124 original_top = f->top_pos;
9125
9126 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9127 unblock_input ();
9128
9129 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9130
9131 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9132 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9133 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9134 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9135
9136 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9137 because the window manager may choose the position
9138 and we don't want to override it. */
9139
9140 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9141 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9142 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9143 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9144 && previously_visible)
9145 {
9146 Drawable rootw;
9147 int x, y;
9148 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9149
9150 block_input ();
9151
9152 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9153 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9154 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9155 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9156 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9157 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9158 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9159 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9160 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9161
9162 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9163 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9164 original_left, original_top);
9165
9166 unblock_input ();
9167 }
9168
9169 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9170
9171 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9172 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9173 MapNotify at all.. */
9174 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9175 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9176 {
9177 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9178 x_sync (f);
9179
9180 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9181 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9182 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9183 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9184 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9185 probably a bug. */
9186 if (input_polling_used ())
9187 {
9188 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9189 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9190 handler reset it. */
9191 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9192 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9193 poll_for_input_1 ();
9194 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9195 }
9196
9197 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9198 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9199 }
9200
9201 /* 2000-09-28: In
9202
9203 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9204 (iconify-frame f)
9205 (raise-frame f))
9206
9207 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9208 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9209 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9210 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9211
9212 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9213 goto retry;
9214 }
9215 }
9216
9217 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9218
9219 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9220
9221 void
9222 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9223 {
9224 Window window;
9225
9226 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9227 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9228
9229 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9230 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9231 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9232
9233 block_input ();
9234
9235 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9236 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9237 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9238 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9239 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9240 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9241
9242 #ifdef USE_GTK
9243 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9244 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9245 else
9246 #else
9247 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9248 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9249 else
9250 #endif
9251 {
9252
9253 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9254 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9255 {
9256 unblock_input ();
9257 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9258 }
9259 }
9260
9261 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9262 just by the event that we get from the server.
9263 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9264 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9265 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9266 f->visible = 0;
9267 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9268 f->async_visible = 0;
9269 f->async_iconified = 0;
9270
9271 x_sync (f);
9272
9273 unblock_input ();
9274 }
9275
9276 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9277
9278 void
9279 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9280 {
9281 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9282 int result;
9283 #endif
9284 Lisp_Object type;
9285
9286 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9287 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9288 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9289
9290 if (f->async_iconified)
9291 return;
9292
9293 block_input ();
9294
9295 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9296
9297 type = x_icon_type (f);
9298 if (!NILP (type))
9299 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9300
9301 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9302 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9303 {
9304 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9305 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9306
9307 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9308 f->iconified = 1;
9309 f->visible = 1;
9310 f->async_iconified = 1;
9311 f->async_visible = 0;
9312 unblock_input ();
9313 return;
9314 }
9315 #endif
9316
9317 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9318
9319 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9320 {
9321 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9322 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9323 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9324 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9325 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9326 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9327 so we have to record it here. */
9328 f->iconified = 1;
9329 f->visible = 1;
9330 f->async_iconified = 1;
9331 f->async_visible = 0;
9332 unblock_input ();
9333 return;
9334 }
9335
9336 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9337 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9338 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9339 unblock_input ();
9340
9341 if (!result)
9342 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9343
9344 f->async_iconified = 1;
9345 f->async_visible = 0;
9346
9347
9348 block_input ();
9349 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9350 unblock_input ();
9351 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9352
9353 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9354 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9355 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9356 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9357 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9358 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9359
9360 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9361 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9362
9363 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9364 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9365 {
9366 XEvent msg;
9367
9368 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9369 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9370 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9371 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9372 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9373
9374 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9375 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9376 False,
9377 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9378 &msg))
9379 {
9380 unblock_input ();
9381 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9382 }
9383 }
9384
9385 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9386 IconicState. */
9387 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9388
9389 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9390 {
9391 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9392 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9393 }
9394
9395 f->async_iconified = 1;
9396 f->async_visible = 0;
9397
9398 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9399 unblock_input ();
9400 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9401 }
9402
9403 \f
9404 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9405
9406 void
9407 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9408 {
9409 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9410 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9411 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9412 Lisp_Object bar;
9413 struct scroll_bar *b;
9414 #endif
9415
9416 block_input ();
9417
9418 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9419 commands to the X server. */
9420 if (dpyinfo->display)
9421 {
9422 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9423 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9424 face. */
9425 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9426 free_frame_faces (f);
9427
9428 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9429 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9430
9431 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9432 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9433 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9434 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9435 toolkit scroll bars. */
9436 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9437 {
9438 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9439 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9440 }
9441 #endif
9442
9443 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9444 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9445 free_frame_xic (f);
9446 #endif
9447
9448 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9449 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9450 {
9451 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9452 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9453 }
9454 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9455 we are using a toolkit. */
9456 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9457 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9458
9459 free_frame_menubar (f);
9460 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9461
9462 #ifdef USE_GTK
9463 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9464 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9465
9466 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9467 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9468 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9469
9470 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9471 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9472 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9473 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9474 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9475 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9476
9477 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9478 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9479 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9480 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9481 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9482 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9483 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9484 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9485 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9486 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9487 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9488 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9489 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9490 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9491 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9492
9493 x_free_gcs (f);
9494 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9495 }
9496
9497 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9498 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9499 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9500
9501 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9502 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9503 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9504 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9505 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9506 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9507
9508 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9509 {
9510 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9511 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9512 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9513 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9514 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9515 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9516 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9517 }
9518
9519 unblock_input ();
9520 }
9521
9522
9523 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9524
9525 static void
9526 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9527 {
9528 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9529
9530 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9531 commands to the X server. */
9532 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9533 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9534
9535 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9536 }
9537
9538 \f
9539 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9540
9541 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9542 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9543 that the window now has.
9544 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9545 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9546 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9547
9548 #ifndef USE_GTK
9549 void
9550 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9551 {
9552 XSizeHints size_hints;
9553 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9554
9555 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9556 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9557 {
9558 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9559 return;
9560 }
9561 #endif
9562
9563 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9564 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9565
9566 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9567 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9568
9569 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9570 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9571
9572 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9573 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9574 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9575 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9576 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9577 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9578
9579 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9580 {
9581 int base_width, base_height;
9582 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9583
9584 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9585 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9586
9587 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9588
9589 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9590 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9591 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9592 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9593 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9594
9595 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9596 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9597 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9598
9599 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9600 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9601 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9602 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9603 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9604 }
9605
9606 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9607 if (flags)
9608 {
9609 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9610 goto no_read;
9611 }
9612
9613 {
9614 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9615 long supplied_return;
9616 int value;
9617
9618 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9619 &supplied_return);
9620
9621 if (flags)
9622 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9623 else
9624 {
9625 if (value == 0)
9626 hints.flags = 0;
9627 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9628 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9629 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9630 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9631 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9632 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9633 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9634 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9635 }
9636 }
9637
9638 no_read:
9639
9640 #ifdef PWinGravity
9641 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9642 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9643
9644 if (user_position)
9645 {
9646 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9647 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9648 }
9649 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9650
9651 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9652 }
9653 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9654
9655 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9656
9657 static void
9658 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9659 {
9660 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9661 Arg al[1];
9662
9663 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9664 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9665 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9666 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9667
9668 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9669 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9670
9671 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9672 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9673 }
9674
9675 static void
9676 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9677 {
9678 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9679
9680 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9681 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9682 #endif
9683
9684 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9685 {
9686 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9687 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9688 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9689 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9690 }
9691 else
9692 {
9693 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9694 pixmap. */
9695 return;
9696 }
9697
9698
9699 #ifdef USE_GTK
9700 {
9701 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9702 return;
9703 }
9704
9705 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9706
9707 {
9708 Arg al[1];
9709 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9710 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9711 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9712 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9713 }
9714
9715 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9716
9717 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9718 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9719
9720 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9721 }
9722
9723 void
9724 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9725 {
9726 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9727
9728 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9729 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9730 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9731
9732 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9733 }
9734
9735 \f
9736 /***********************************************************************
9737 Fonts
9738 ***********************************************************************/
9739
9740 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9741
9742 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9743 font table. */
9744
9745 static void
9746 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9747 {
9748 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9749 if (font->driver->check)
9750 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9751 }
9752
9753 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9754
9755 \f
9756 /***********************************************************************
9757 Initialization
9758 ***********************************************************************/
9759
9760 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9761 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9762 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9763 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9764
9765 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9766 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9767 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9768
9769 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9770 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9771 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9772 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9773 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9774 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9775 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9776 };
9777
9778 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9779
9780 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9781
9782 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9783
9784 static int x_initialized;
9785
9786 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9787 the screen number from the server number. */
9788 static int
9789 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9790 {
9791 int seen_colon = 0;
9792 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9793 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9794 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9795
9796 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9797 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9798 length_until_period++;
9799
9800 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9801 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9802 name1 += 4;
9803 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9804 name2 += 4;
9805 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9806 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9807 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9808 name1 += system_name_length;
9809 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9810 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9811 name2 += system_name_length;
9812 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9813 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9814 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9815 name1 += length_until_period;
9816 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9817 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9818 name2 += length_until_period;
9819
9820 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9821 {
9822 if (*name1 == ':')
9823 seen_colon = 1;
9824 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9825 return 1;
9826 }
9827 return (seen_colon
9828 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9829 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9830 }
9831
9832 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9833 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9834 to 5. */
9835 static void
9836 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9837 {
9838 int nr = 0;
9839 int off = 0;
9840
9841 while (!(mask & 1))
9842 {
9843 off++;
9844 mask >>= 1;
9845 }
9846
9847 while (mask & 1)
9848 {
9849 nr++;
9850 mask >>= 1;
9851 }
9852
9853 *offset = off;
9854 *bits = nr;
9855 }
9856
9857 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9858 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9859
9860 int
9861 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9862 {
9863 int dpy_ok = 1;
9864 Display *dpy;
9865
9866 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9867 if (dpy)
9868 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9869 else
9870 dpy_ok = 0;
9871 return dpy_ok;
9872 }
9873
9874 #ifdef USE_GTK
9875 static void
9876 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9877 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9878 {
9879 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9880 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9881 }
9882 #endif
9883
9884 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9885 the structure that describes the open display.
9886 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9887
9888 struct x_display_info *
9889 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9890 {
9891 int connection;
9892 Display *dpy;
9893 struct terminal *terminal;
9894 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9895 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9896 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9897 ptrdiff_t lim;
9898
9899 block_input ();
9900
9901 if (!x_initialized)
9902 {
9903 x_initialize ();
9904 ++x_initialized;
9905 }
9906
9907 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9908 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9909
9910 #ifdef USE_GTK
9911 {
9912 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9913 int argc;
9914 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9915 char **argv2 = argv;
9916 guint id;
9917
9918 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9919 {
9920 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9921 }
9922 else
9923 {
9924 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9925 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9926
9927 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9928 argv[argc] = 0;
9929
9930 argc = 0;
9931 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9932
9933 if (! NILP (display_name))
9934 {
9935 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9936 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9937 }
9938
9939 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9940 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9941
9942 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9943
9944 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9945 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9946 {
9947 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9948 putenv (fix_events);
9949 }
9950
9951 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9952 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9953 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9954 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9955
9956 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9957 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9958 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9959
9960 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9961 fixup_locale ();
9962 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9963 fixup_locale ();
9964
9965 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9966
9967 xg_initialize ();
9968
9969 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9970
9971 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9972 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9973 {
9974 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9975 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9976
9977 s = build_string (file);
9978 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9979
9980 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9981 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9982 }
9983 #endif
9984
9985 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9986 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9987 }
9988 }
9989 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9990 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9991 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9992 errors with X11R5:
9993 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9994 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9995 So let's not use it until R6. */
9996 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9997 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9998 #endif
9999
10000 {
10001 int argc = 0;
10002 char *argv[3];
10003
10004 argv[0] = "";
10005 argc = 1;
10006 if (xrm_option)
10007 {
10008 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10009 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10010 }
10011 turn_on_atimers (0);
10012 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10013 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10014 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10015 &argc, argv);
10016 turn_on_atimers (1);
10017
10018 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10019 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10020 fixup_locale ();
10021 #endif
10022 }
10023
10024 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10025 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10026 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10027 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10028 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10029
10030 /* Detect failure. */
10031 if (dpy == 0)
10032 {
10033 unblock_input ();
10034 return 0;
10035 }
10036
10037 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10038
10039 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10040 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10041
10042 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10043
10044 {
10045 struct x_display_info *share;
10046 Lisp_Object tail;
10047
10048 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10049 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10050 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10051 SSDATA (display_name)))
10052 break;
10053 if (share)
10054 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10055 else
10056 {
10057 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10058 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10059 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10060
10061 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10062 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10063 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10064 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10065 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10066
10067 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10068 {
10069 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10070
10071 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10072 list of terminals. */
10073 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10074 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10075 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10076 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10077
10078 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10079 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10080 unblock_input ();
10081 kset_system_key_alist
10082 (terminal->kboard,
10083 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10084 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10085 block_input ();
10086 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10087 terminal_list = terminal;
10088 UNGCPRO;
10089 }
10090
10091 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10092 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10093 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10094 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10095 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10096 }
10097 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10098 }
10099
10100 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10101 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10102 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10103
10104 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10105 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10106 x_display_name_list);
10107 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10108
10109 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10110
10111 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10112 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10113 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10114 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10115
10116 #if 0
10117 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10118 #endif /* ! 0 */
10119
10120 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10121 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10122 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10123 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10124 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10125 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10126 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10127
10128 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10129 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10130
10131 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10132 #ifdef USE_GTK
10133 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10134 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10135 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10136
10137 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10138 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10139
10140 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10141 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10142 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10143 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10144 #else
10145 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10146 #endif
10147 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10148 all versions. */
10149 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10150
10151 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10152 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10153 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10154 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10155 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10156 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10157 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10158 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10159 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10160 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10161 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10162 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10163 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10164 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10165 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10166 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10167 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10168 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10169 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10170 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10171 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10172 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10173 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10174 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10175 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10176 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10177 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10178 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10179
10180 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10181 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10182 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10183
10184 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10185 {
10186 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10187 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10188 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10189 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10190 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10191 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10192 }
10193
10194 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10195 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10196 {
10197 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10198 {
10199 Lisp_Object value;
10200 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10201 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10202 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10203 Qnil, Qnil);
10204 if (STRINGP (value)
10205 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10206 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10207 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10208 }
10209 }
10210 else
10211 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10212 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10213
10214 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10215 {
10216 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10217 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10218 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10219 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10220 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10221 for example). */
10222 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10223 double d;
10224 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10225 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10226 }
10227 #endif
10228
10229 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10230 {
10231 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10232 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10233 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10234 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10235 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10236 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10237 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10238 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10239 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10240 }
10241
10242 {
10243 const struct
10244 {
10245 const char *name;
10246 Atom *atom;
10247 } atom_refs[] = {
10248 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10249 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10250 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10251 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10252 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10253 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10254 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10255 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10256 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10257 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10258 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10259 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10260 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10261 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10262 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10263 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10264 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10265 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10266 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10267 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10268 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10269 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10270 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10271 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10272 /* For properties of font. */
10273 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10274 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10275 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10276 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10277 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10278 /* Ghostscript support. */
10279 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10280 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10281 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10282 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10283 /* EWMH */
10284 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10285 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10286 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10287 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10288 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10289 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10290 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10291 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10292 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10293 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10294 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10295 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10296 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10297 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10298 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10299 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10300 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10301 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10302 /* Session management */
10303 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10304 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10305 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10306 };
10307
10308 int i;
10309 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10310 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10311 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10312 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10313 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10314 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10315 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10316 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10317
10318 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10319 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10320
10321 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10322 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10323 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10324 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10325
10326 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10327 False, atoms_return);
10328
10329 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10330 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10331
10332 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10333 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10334
10335 xfree (atom_names);
10336 xfree (atoms_return);
10337 }
10338
10339 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10340 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10342 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10343
10344 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10345 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10346 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10347
10348 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10349 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10350 dpyinfo->gray
10351 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10352 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10353 1, 0, 1);
10354
10355 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10356 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10357 #endif
10358
10359 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10360
10361 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10362 if (connection != 0)
10363 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10364
10365 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10366 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10367 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10368
10369 if (interrupt_input)
10370 init_sigio (connection);
10371
10372 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10373 {
10374 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10375 Font font;
10376
10377 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10378 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10379 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10380 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10381 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10382 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10383 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10384 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10385 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10386 emacs_abort ();
10387 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10388 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10389 x_uncatch_errors ();
10390 }
10391 #endif
10392
10393 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10394 for debugging X code. */
10395 {
10396 Lisp_Object value;
10397 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10398 build_string ("synchronous"),
10399 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10400 Qnil, Qnil);
10401 if (STRINGP (value)
10402 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10403 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10404 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10405 }
10406
10407 {
10408 Lisp_Object value;
10409 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10410 build_string ("useXIM"),
10411 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10412 Qnil, Qnil);
10413 #ifdef USE_XIM
10414 if (STRINGP (value)
10415 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10416 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10417 use_xim = 0;
10418 #else
10419 if (STRINGP (value)
10420 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10421 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10422 use_xim = 1;
10423 #endif
10424 }
10425
10426 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10427 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10428 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10429 tty. */
10430 if (terminal->id == 1)
10431 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10432 #endif
10433
10434 unblock_input ();
10435
10436 return dpyinfo;
10437 }
10438 \f
10439 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10440 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10441
10442 static void
10443 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10444 {
10445 struct terminal *t;
10446
10447 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10448 X display. */
10449 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10450 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10451 {
10452 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10453 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10454 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10455 x_session_close ();
10456 #endif
10457 delete_terminal (t);
10458 break;
10459 }
10460
10461 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10462
10463 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10464 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10465 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10466 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10467 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10468 else
10469 {
10470 Lisp_Object tail;
10471
10472 tail = x_display_name_list;
10473 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10474 {
10475 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10476 {
10477 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10478 break;
10479 }
10480 tail = XCDR (tail);
10481 }
10482 }
10483
10484 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10485 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10486
10487 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10488 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10489 else
10490 {
10491 struct x_display_info *tail;
10492
10493 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10494 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10495 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10496 }
10497
10498 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10499 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10500 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10501 xfree (dpyinfo);
10502 }
10503
10504 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10505
10506 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10507 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10508 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10509 that slows us down. */
10510
10511 static void
10512 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10513 {
10514 block_input ();
10515 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10516 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10517 {
10518 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10519 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10520 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10521 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10522 }
10523 unblock_input ();
10524 }
10525
10526 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10527 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10528 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10529 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10530 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10531 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10532 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10533
10534 void
10535 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10536 {
10537 block_input ();
10538 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10539 {
10540 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10541 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10542 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10543 }
10544 unblock_input ();
10545 }
10546
10547 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10548
10549 \f
10550 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10551
10552 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10553 {
10554 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10555 x_produce_glyphs,
10556 x_write_glyphs,
10557 x_insert_glyphs,
10558 x_clear_end_of_line,
10559 x_scroll_run,
10560 x_after_update_window_line,
10561 x_update_window_begin,
10562 x_update_window_end,
10563 x_cursor_to,
10564 x_flush,
10565 #ifdef XFlush
10566 x_flush,
10567 #else
10568 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10569 #endif
10570 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10571 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10572 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10573 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10574 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10575 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10576 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10577 x_draw_glyph_string,
10578 x_define_frame_cursor,
10579 x_clear_frame_area,
10580 x_draw_window_cursor,
10581 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10582 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10583 };
10584
10585
10586 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10587 void
10588 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10589 {
10590 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10591
10592 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10593 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10594 if (!terminal->name)
10595 return;
10596
10597 block_input ();
10598 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10599 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10600 X display. */
10601 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10602 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10603 #endif
10604
10605 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10606 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10607 if (dpyinfo->display)
10608 {
10609 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10610 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10611
10612 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10613 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10614 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10615 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10616
10617 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10618 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10619 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10620 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10621 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10622 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10623 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10624 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10625 leaks in other situations. */
10626 #if 0
10627 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10628 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10629 #else
10630 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10631 #endif
10632 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10633 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10634 closing all the displays. */
10635 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10636 #endif
10637
10638 #ifdef USE_GTK
10639 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10640 #else
10641 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10642 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10643 #else
10644 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10645 #endif
10646 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10647 }
10648
10649 /* Mark as dead. */
10650 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10651 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10652 unblock_input ();
10653 }
10654
10655 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10656 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10657
10658 static struct terminal *
10659 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10660 {
10661 struct terminal *terminal;
10662
10663 terminal = create_terminal ();
10664
10665 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10666 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10667 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10668
10669 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10670
10671 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10672 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10673 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10674 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10675 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10676 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10677 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10678 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10679 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10680 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10681 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10682 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10683 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10684 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10685 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10686 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10687 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10688 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10689 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10690 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10691
10692 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10693 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10694
10695 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10696 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10697 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10698 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10699 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10700 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10701 off the bottom. */
10702
10703 return terminal;
10704 }
10705
10706 void
10707 x_initialize (void)
10708 {
10709 baud_rate = 19200;
10710
10711 x_noop_count = 0;
10712 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10713 any_help_event_p = 0;
10714 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10715
10716 #ifdef USE_GTK
10717 current_count = -1;
10718 #endif
10719
10720 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10721 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10722
10723 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10724 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10725
10726 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10727
10728 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10729 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10730 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10731 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10732 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10733 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10734 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10735
10736 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10737 #endif
10738
10739 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10740 #ifndef USE_GTK
10741 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10742 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10743 #endif
10744 #endif
10745
10746 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10747 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10748 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10749
10750 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10751 original error handler. */
10752 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10753 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10754 }
10755
10756
10757 void
10758 syms_of_xterm (void)
10759 {
10760 x_error_message = NULL;
10761
10762 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10763 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10764
10765 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10766 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10767
10768 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10769 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10770
10771 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10772 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10773
10774 #ifdef USE_GTK
10775 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10776 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10777
10778 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10779 #endif
10780
10781 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10782 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10783 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10784 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10785 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10786 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10787 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10788 sizes. */);
10789 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10790
10791 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10792 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10793 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10794 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10795 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10796 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10797 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10798
10799 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10800 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10801 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10802 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10803 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10804 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10805 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10806 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10807 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10808
10809 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10810 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10811 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10812 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10813 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10814 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10815 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10816 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10817 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10818 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10819 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10820 #elif USE_GTK
10821 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10822 #else
10823 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10824 #endif
10825 #else
10826 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10827 #endif
10828
10829 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10830 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10831
10832 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10833 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10834 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10835 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10836 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10837 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10838 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10839 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10840 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10841
10842 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10843 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10844 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10845 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10846 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10847 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10848
10849 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10850 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10851 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10852 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10853 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10854 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10855
10856 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10857 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10858 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10859 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10860 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10861 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10862
10863 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10864 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10865 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10866 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10867 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10868 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10869
10870 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10871 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10872 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10873 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10874 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10875 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10876 }
10877
10878 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */